Mercurial > emacs
annotate lispref/modes.texi @ 59440:42dbbd20dc2d
*** empty log message ***
author | Jay Belanger <jay.p.belanger@gmail.com> |
---|---|
date | Sun, 09 Jan 2005 16:24:30 +0000 |
parents | f1eb5a3ef974 |
children | 8732f8552b7d |
rev | line source |
---|---|
6451 | 1 @c -*-texinfo-*- |
2 @c This is part of the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. | |
57213
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
3 @c Copyright (C) 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1998, 1999, 2003, 2004 |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
6451 | 5 @c See the file elisp.texi for copying conditions. |
6 @setfilename ../info/modes | |
52197
a0b65ecec014
*** empty log message ***
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents:
52195
diff
changeset
|
7 @node Modes, Documentation, Keymaps, Top |
6451 | 8 @chapter Major and Minor Modes |
9 @cindex mode | |
10 | |
11 A @dfn{mode} is a set of definitions that customize Emacs and can be | |
12 turned on and off while you edit. There are two varieties of modes: | |
13 @dfn{major modes}, which are mutually exclusive and used for editing | |
14 particular kinds of text, and @dfn{minor modes}, which provide features | |
15 that users can enable individually. | |
16 | |
17 This chapter describes how to write both major and minor modes, how to | |
18 indicate them in the mode line, and how they run hooks supplied by the | |
19 user. For related topics such as keymaps and syntax tables, see | |
20 @ref{Keymaps}, and @ref{Syntax Tables}. | |
21 | |
22 @menu | |
23 * Major Modes:: Defining major modes. | |
24 * Minor Modes:: Defining minor modes. | |
25 * Mode Line Format:: Customizing the text that appears in the mode line. | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
26 * Imenu:: How a mode can provide a menu |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
27 of definitions in the buffer. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
28 * Font Lock Mode:: How modes can highlight text according to syntax. |
55414 | 29 * Desktop Save Mode:: How modes can have buffer state saved between |
30 Emacs sessions. | |
6451 | 31 * Hooks:: How to use hooks; how to write code that provides hooks. |
32 @end menu | |
33 | |
34 @node Major Modes | |
35 @section Major Modes | |
36 @cindex major mode | |
37 @cindex Fundamental mode | |
38 | |
39 Major modes specialize Emacs for editing particular kinds of text. | |
43677
8d02880abeaa
(Major Modes): Explain major mode functions, how they work, and how
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
43264
diff
changeset
|
40 Each buffer has only one major mode at a time. For each major mode |
8d02880abeaa
(Major Modes): Explain major mode functions, how they work, and how
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
43264
diff
changeset
|
41 there is a function to switch to that mode in the current buffer; its |
8d02880abeaa
(Major Modes): Explain major mode functions, how they work, and how
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
43264
diff
changeset
|
42 name should end in @samp{-mode}. These functions work by setting |
8d02880abeaa
(Major Modes): Explain major mode functions, how they work, and how
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
43264
diff
changeset
|
43 buffer-local variable bindings and other data associated with the |
8d02880abeaa
(Major Modes): Explain major mode functions, how they work, and how
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
43264
diff
changeset
|
44 buffer, such as a local keymap. The effect lasts until you switch |
8d02880abeaa
(Major Modes): Explain major mode functions, how they work, and how
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
43264
diff
changeset
|
45 to another major mode in the same buffer. |
6451 | 46 |
47 The least specialized major mode is called @dfn{Fundamental mode}. | |
48 This mode has no mode-specific definitions or variable settings, so each | |
49 Emacs command behaves in its default manner, and each option is in its | |
50 default state. All other major modes redefine various keys and options. | |
51 For example, Lisp Interaction mode provides special key bindings for | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
52 @kbd{C-j} (@code{eval-print-last-sexp}), @key{TAB} |
6451 | 53 (@code{lisp-indent-line}), and other keys. |
54 | |
55 When you need to write several editing commands to help you perform a | |
56 specialized editing task, creating a new major mode is usually a good | |
57 idea. In practice, writing a major mode is easy (in contrast to | |
58 writing a minor mode, which is often difficult). | |
59 | |
60 If the new mode is similar to an old one, it is often unwise to modify | |
61 the old one to serve two purposes, since it may become harder to use and | |
62 maintain. Instead, copy and rename an existing major mode definition | |
63 and alter the copy---or define a @dfn{derived mode} (@pxref{Derived | |
64 Modes}). For example, Rmail Edit mode, which is in | |
25875 | 65 @file{emacs/lisp/mail/rmailedit.el}, is a major mode that is very similar to |
66 Text mode except that it provides two additional commands. Its | |
67 definition is distinct from that of Text mode, but uses that of Text mode. | |
6451 | 68 |
28603
cb9db16dba12
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27390
diff
changeset
|
69 Even if the new mode is not an obvious derivative of any other mode, |
39793
1d5b7d31671f
Recommend the use of define-derived-mode (and nil argument).
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
38200
diff
changeset
|
70 it is convenient to use @code{define-derived-mode} with a @code{nil} |
1d5b7d31671f
Recommend the use of define-derived-mode (and nil argument).
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
38200
diff
changeset
|
71 parent argument, since it automatically enforces the most important |
1d5b7d31671f
Recommend the use of define-derived-mode (and nil argument).
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
38200
diff
changeset
|
72 coding conventions for you. |
28603
cb9db16dba12
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27390
diff
changeset
|
73 |
46914
56bbdfd75143
Mention define-generic-mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
45714
diff
changeset
|
74 @findex define-generic-mode |
56bbdfd75143
Mention define-generic-mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
45714
diff
changeset
|
75 For a very simple programming language major mode that handles |
56bbdfd75143
Mention define-generic-mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
45714
diff
changeset
|
76 comments and fontification, you can use @code{define-generic-mode} |
56bbdfd75143
Mention define-generic-mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
45714
diff
changeset
|
77 in @file{generic.el}. |
56bbdfd75143
Mention define-generic-mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
45714
diff
changeset
|
78 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
79 Rmail Edit mode offers an example of changing the major mode |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
80 temporarily for a buffer, so it can be edited in a different way (with |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
81 ordinary Emacs commands rather than Rmail commands). In such cases, the |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
82 temporary major mode usually provides a command to switch back to the |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
83 buffer's usual mode (Rmail mode, in this case). You might be tempted to |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
84 present the temporary redefinitions inside a recursive edit and restore |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
85 the usual ones when the user exits; but this is a bad idea because it |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
86 constrains the user's options when it is done in more than one buffer: |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
87 recursive edits must be exited most-recently-entered first. Using an |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
88 alternative major mode avoids this limitation. @xref{Recursive |
6451 | 89 Editing}. |
90 | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
91 The standard GNU Emacs Lisp library directory tree contains the code |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
92 for several major modes, in files such as @file{text-mode.el}, |
6451 | 93 @file{texinfo.el}, @file{lisp-mode.el}, @file{c-mode.el}, and |
25875 | 94 @file{rmail.el}. They are found in various subdirectories of the |
95 @file{lisp} directory. You can study these libraries to see how modes | |
96 are written. Text mode is perhaps the simplest major mode aside from | |
6451 | 97 Fundamental mode. Rmail mode is a complicated and specialized mode. |
98 | |
99 @menu | |
100 * Major Mode Conventions:: Coding conventions for keymaps, etc. | |
101 * Example Major Modes:: Text mode and Lisp modes. | |
102 * Auto Major Mode:: How Emacs chooses the major mode automatically. | |
103 * Mode Help:: Finding out how to use a mode. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
104 * Derived Modes:: Defining a new major mode based on another major |
6451 | 105 mode. |
57213
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
106 * Mode Hooks:: Hooks run at the end of major mode functions. |
6451 | 107 @end menu |
108 | |
109 @node Major Mode Conventions | |
110 @subsection Major Mode Conventions | |
111 | |
112 The code for existing major modes follows various coding conventions, | |
113 including conventions for local keymap and syntax table initialization, | |
114 global names, and hooks. Please follow these conventions when you | |
38200
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
115 define a new major mode. |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
116 |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
117 This list of conventions is only partial, because each major mode |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
118 should aim for consistency in general with other Emacs major modes. |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
119 This makes Emacs as a whole more coherent. It is impossible to list |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
120 here all the possible points where this issue might come up; if the |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
121 Emacs developers point out an area where your major mode deviates from |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
122 the usual conventions, please make it compatible. |
6451 | 123 |
124 @itemize @bullet | |
125 @item | |
126 Define a command whose name ends in @samp{-mode}, with no arguments, | |
127 that switches to the new mode in the current buffer. This command | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
128 should set up the keymap, syntax table, and buffer-local variables in an |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
129 existing buffer, without changing the buffer's contents. |
6451 | 130 |
131 @item | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
132 Write a documentation string for this command that describes the |
6451 | 133 special commands available in this mode. @kbd{C-h m} |
134 (@code{describe-mode}) in your mode will display this string. | |
135 | |
136 The documentation string may include the special documentation | |
137 substrings, @samp{\[@var{command}]}, @samp{\@{@var{keymap}@}}, and | |
24934 | 138 @samp{\<@var{keymap}>}, which enable the documentation to adapt |
6451 | 139 automatically to the user's own key bindings. @xref{Keys in |
140 Documentation}. | |
141 | |
142 @item | |
143 The major mode command should start by calling | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
144 @code{kill-all-local-variables}. This is what gets rid of the |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
145 buffer-local variables of the major mode previously in effect. |
6451 | 146 |
147 @item | |
148 The major mode command should set the variable @code{major-mode} to the | |
149 major mode command symbol. This is how @code{describe-mode} discovers | |
150 which documentation to print. | |
151 | |
152 @item | |
153 The major mode command should set the variable @code{mode-name} to the | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
154 ``pretty'' name of the mode, as a string. This string appears in the |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
155 mode line. |
6451 | 156 |
157 @item | |
158 @cindex functions in modes | |
159 Since all global names are in the same name space, all the global | |
160 variables, constants, and functions that are part of the mode should | |
161 have names that start with the major mode name (or with an abbreviation | |
17278
8ed8412c1ce7
Document key binding conventions for major modes and minor modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16432
diff
changeset
|
162 of it if the name is long). @xref{Coding Conventions}. |
6451 | 163 |
164 @item | |
38200
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
165 In a major mode for editing some kind of structured text, such as a |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
166 programming language, indentation of text according to structure is |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
167 probably useful. So the mode should set @code{indent-line-function} |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
168 to a suitable function, and probably customize other variables |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
169 for indentation. |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
170 |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
171 @item |
6451 | 172 @cindex keymaps in modes |
173 The major mode should usually have its own keymap, which is used as the | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
174 local keymap in all buffers in that mode. The major mode command should |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
175 call @code{use-local-map} to install this local map. @xref{Active |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
176 Keymaps}, for more information. |
6451 | 177 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
178 This keymap should be stored permanently in a global variable named |
6451 | 179 @code{@var{modename}-mode-map}. Normally the library that defines the |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
180 mode sets this variable. |
6451 | 181 |
12803
6dcd5ad16790
Make Major Mode Conventions xref to Tips for Defining.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12234
diff
changeset
|
182 @xref{Tips for Defining}, for advice about how to write the code to set |
6dcd5ad16790
Make Major Mode Conventions xref to Tips for Defining.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12234
diff
changeset
|
183 up the mode's keymap variable. |
6dcd5ad16790
Make Major Mode Conventions xref to Tips for Defining.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12234
diff
changeset
|
184 |
6451 | 185 @item |
17278
8ed8412c1ce7
Document key binding conventions for major modes and minor modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16432
diff
changeset
|
186 The key sequences bound in a major mode keymap should usually start with |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
187 @kbd{C-c}, followed by a control character, a digit, or @kbd{@{}, |
17278
8ed8412c1ce7
Document key binding conventions for major modes and minor modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16432
diff
changeset
|
188 @kbd{@}}, @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, @kbd{:} or @kbd{;}. The other punctuation |
8ed8412c1ce7
Document key binding conventions for major modes and minor modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16432
diff
changeset
|
189 characters are reserved for minor modes, and ordinary letters are |
8ed8412c1ce7
Document key binding conventions for major modes and minor modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16432
diff
changeset
|
190 reserved for users. |
8ed8412c1ce7
Document key binding conventions for major modes and minor modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16432
diff
changeset
|
191 |
56768
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
192 A major mode can also rebind the keys @kbd{M-n}, @kbd{M-p} and |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
193 @kbd{M-s}. The bindings for @kbd{M-n} and @kbd{M-p} should normally |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
194 be some kind of ``moving forward and backward,'' but this does not |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
195 necessarily mean cursor motion. |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
196 |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
197 It is legitimate for a major mode to rebind a standard key sequence if |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
198 it provides a command that does ``the same job'' in a way better |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
199 suited to the text this mode is used for. For example, a major mode |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
200 for editing a programming language might redefine @kbd{C-M-a} to |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
201 ``move to the beginning of a function'' in a way that works better for |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
202 that language. |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
203 |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
204 It is also legitimate for a major mode to rebind a standard key |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
205 sequence whose standard meaning is rarely useful in that mode. For |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
206 instance, minibuffer modes rebind @kbd{M-r}, whose standard meaning is |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
207 rarely of any use in the minibuffer. Major modes such as Dired or |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
208 Rmail that do not allow self-insertion of text can reasonably redefine |
560751ade8e5
(Major Mode Conventions): Discuss rebinding of standard key bindings.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55831
diff
changeset
|
209 letters and other printing characters as special commands. |
17278
8ed8412c1ce7
Document key binding conventions for major modes and minor modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16432
diff
changeset
|
210 |
8ed8412c1ce7
Document key binding conventions for major modes and minor modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16432
diff
changeset
|
211 @item |
38161
45d64a431eea
(Major Mode Conventions): Major modes should not change RET.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
36347
diff
changeset
|
212 Major modes must not define @key{RET} to do anything other than insert |
45d64a431eea
(Major Mode Conventions): Major modes should not change RET.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
36347
diff
changeset
|
213 a newline. The command to insert a newline and then indent is |
38200
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
214 @kbd{C-j}. Please keep this distinction uniform for all major modes. |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
215 |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
216 @item |
54041 | 217 Major modes should not alter options that are primarily a matter of user |
38200
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
218 preference, such as whether Auto-Fill mode is enabled. Leave this to |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
219 each user to decide. However, a major mode should customize other |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
220 variables so that Auto-Fill mode will work usefully @emph{if} the user |
6c286c714f74
(Major Mode Conventions): Say not to change meaning of RET, and not to
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
38161
diff
changeset
|
221 decides to use it. |
38161
45d64a431eea
(Major Mode Conventions): Major modes should not change RET.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
36347
diff
changeset
|
222 |
45d64a431eea
(Major Mode Conventions): Major modes should not change RET.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
36347
diff
changeset
|
223 @item |
6451 | 224 @cindex syntax tables in modes |
225 The mode may have its own syntax table or may share one with other | |
226 related modes. If it has its own syntax table, it should store this in | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
227 a variable named @code{@var{modename}-mode-syntax-table}. @xref{Syntax |
6451 | 228 Tables}. |
229 | |
230 @item | |
16432
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
231 If the mode handles a language that has a syntax for comments, it should |
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
232 set the variables that define the comment syntax. @xref{Options for |
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
233 Comments,, Options Controlling Comments, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}. |
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
234 |
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
235 @item |
6451 | 236 @cindex abbrev tables in modes |
237 The mode may have its own abbrev table or may share one with other | |
238 related modes. If it has its own abbrev table, it should store this in | |
239 a variable named @code{@var{modename}-mode-abbrev-table}. @xref{Abbrev | |
240 Tables}. | |
241 | |
242 @item | |
16432
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
243 The mode should specify how to do highlighting for Font Lock mode, by |
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
244 setting up a buffer-local value for the variable |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
245 @code{font-lock-defaults} (@pxref{Font Lock Mode}). |
16432
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
246 |
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
247 @item |
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
248 The mode should specify how Imenu should find the definitions or |
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
249 sections of a buffer, by setting up a buffer-local value for the |
52744
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
250 variable @code{imenu-generic-expression}, for the pair of variables |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
251 @code{imenu-prev-index-position-function} and |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
252 @code{imenu-extract-index-name-function}, or for the variable |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
253 @code{imenu-create-index-function} (@pxref{Imenu}). |
16432
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
254 |
6f58503776e5
Explain what major modes can do for imenu and font-lock.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16056
diff
changeset
|
255 @item |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
256 Use @code{defvar} or @code{defcustom} to set mode-related variables, so |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
257 that they are not reinitialized if they already have a value. (Such |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
258 reinitialization could discard customizations made by the user.) |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
259 |
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
260 @item |
6451 | 261 @cindex buffer-local variables in modes |
262 To make a buffer-local binding for an Emacs customization variable, use | |
263 @code{make-local-variable} in the major mode command, not | |
264 @code{make-variable-buffer-local}. The latter function would make the | |
265 variable local to every buffer in which it is subsequently set, which | |
266 would affect buffers that do not use this mode. It is undesirable for a | |
267 mode to have such global effects. @xref{Buffer-Local Variables}. | |
268 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
269 With rare exceptions, the only reasonable way to use |
25875 | 270 @code{make-variable-buffer-local} in a Lisp package is for a variable |
271 which is used only within that package. Using it on a variable used by | |
272 other packages would interfere with them. | |
6451 | 273 |
274 @item | |
275 @cindex mode hook | |
276 @cindex major mode hook | |
277 Each major mode should have a @dfn{mode hook} named | |
278 @code{@var{modename}-mode-hook}. The major mode command should run that | |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
279 hook, with @code{run-mode-hooks}, as the very last thing it |
57213
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
280 does. @xref{Mode Hooks}. |
6451 | 281 |
282 @item | |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
283 The major mode command may start by calling some other major mode |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
284 command (called the @dfn{parent mode}) and then alter some of its |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
285 settings. A mode that does this is called a @dfn{derived mode}. The |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
286 recommended way to define one is to use @code{define-derived-mode}, |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
287 but this is not required. Such a mode should use |
57213
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
288 @code{delay-mode-hooks} around its entire body (including the call to |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
289 the parent mode command) @emph{except} for the final call to |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
290 @code{run-mode-hooks}, which runs the derived mode's hook. (Using |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
291 @code{define-derived-mode} does this automatically.) @xref{Derived |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
292 Modes}, and @ref{Mode Hooks}. |
6451 | 293 |
294 @item | |
295 If something special should be done if the user switches a buffer from | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
296 this mode to any other major mode, this mode can set up a buffer-local |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
297 value for @code{change-major-mode-hook} (@pxref{Creating Buffer-Local}). |
6451 | 298 |
299 @item | |
300 If this mode is appropriate only for specially-prepared text, then the | |
301 major mode command symbol should have a property named @code{mode-class} | |
302 with value @code{special}, put on as follows: | |
303 | |
51021
59fa0bb3f282
Index mode-class using @kindex.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
50693
diff
changeset
|
304 @kindex mode-class @r{(property)} |
6451 | 305 @cindex @code{special} |
306 @example | |
307 (put 'funny-mode 'mode-class 'special) | |
308 @end example | |
309 | |
310 @noindent | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
311 This tells Emacs that new buffers created while the current buffer is in |
6451 | 312 Funny mode should not inherit Funny mode. Modes such as Dired, Rmail, |
313 and Buffer List use this feature. | |
314 | |
315 @item | |
316 If you want to make the new mode the default for files with certain | |
317 recognizable names, add an element to @code{auto-mode-alist} to select | |
318 the mode for those file names. If you define the mode command to | |
319 autoload, you should add this element in the same file that calls | |
320 @code{autoload}. Otherwise, it is sufficient to add the element in the | |
321 file that contains the mode definition. @xref{Auto Major Mode}. | |
322 | |
323 @item | |
324 In the documentation, you should provide a sample @code{autoload} form | |
325 and an example of how to add to @code{auto-mode-alist}, that users can | |
25875 | 326 include in their init files (@pxref{Init File}). |
6451 | 327 |
328 @item | |
329 @cindex mode loading | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
330 The top-level forms in the file defining the mode should be written so |
6451 | 331 that they may be evaluated more than once without adverse consequences. |
332 Even if you never load the file more than once, someone else will. | |
333 @end itemize | |
334 | |
335 @node Example Major Modes | |
336 @subsection Major Mode Examples | |
337 | |
338 Text mode is perhaps the simplest mode besides Fundamental mode. | |
339 Here are excerpts from @file{text-mode.el} that illustrate many of | |
340 the conventions listed above: | |
341 | |
342 @smallexample | |
343 @group | |
344 ;; @r{Create mode-specific tables.} | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
345 (defvar text-mode-syntax-table nil |
6451 | 346 "Syntax table used while in text mode.") |
347 @end group | |
348 | |
349 @group | |
350 (if text-mode-syntax-table | |
351 () ; @r{Do not change the table if it is already set up.} | |
352 (setq text-mode-syntax-table (make-syntax-table)) | |
353 (modify-syntax-entry ?\" ". " text-mode-syntax-table) | |
354 (modify-syntax-entry ?\\ ". " text-mode-syntax-table) | |
355 (modify-syntax-entry ?' "w " text-mode-syntax-table)) | |
356 @end group | |
357 | |
358 @group | |
359 (defvar text-mode-abbrev-table nil | |
360 "Abbrev table used while in text mode.") | |
361 (define-abbrev-table 'text-mode-abbrev-table ()) | |
362 @end group | |
363 | |
364 @group | |
25875 | 365 (defvar text-mode-map nil ; @r{Create a mode-specific keymap.} |
366 "Keymap for Text mode. | |
367 Many other modes, such as Mail mode, Outline mode and Indented Text mode, | |
368 inherit all the commands defined in this map.") | |
6451 | 369 |
370 (if text-mode-map | |
371 () ; @r{Do not change the keymap if it is already set up.} | |
372 (setq text-mode-map (make-sparse-keymap)) | |
25875 | 373 (define-key text-mode-map "\e\t" 'ispell-complete-word) |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
374 (define-key text-mode-map "\t" 'indent-relative) |
6451 | 375 (define-key text-mode-map "\es" 'center-line) |
376 (define-key text-mode-map "\eS" 'center-paragraph)) | |
377 @end group | |
378 @end smallexample | |
379 | |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
380 This was formerly the complete major mode function definition for Text mode: |
6451 | 381 |
382 @smallexample | |
383 @group | |
384 (defun text-mode () | |
25950
7996385fc601
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
385 "Major mode for editing text intended for humans to read... |
6451 | 386 Special commands: \\@{text-mode-map@} |
387 @end group | |
388 @group | |
389 Turning on text-mode runs the hook `text-mode-hook'." | |
390 (interactive) | |
391 (kill-all-local-variables) | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
392 (use-local-map text-mode-map) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
393 @end group |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
394 @group |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
395 (setq local-abbrev-table text-mode-abbrev-table) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
396 (set-syntax-table text-mode-syntax-table) |
6451 | 397 @end group |
398 @group | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
399 (make-local-variable 'paragraph-start) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
400 (setq paragraph-start (concat "[ \t]*$\\|" page-delimiter)) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
401 (make-local-variable 'paragraph-separate) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
402 (setq paragraph-separate paragraph-start) |
25875 | 403 (make-local-variable 'indent-line-function) |
404 (setq indent-line-function 'indent-relative-maybe) | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
405 @end group |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
406 @group |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
407 (setq mode-name "Text") |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
408 (setq major-mode 'text-mode) |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
409 (run-mode-hooks 'text-mode-hook)) ; @r{Finally, this permits the user to} |
6451 | 410 ; @r{customize the mode with a hook.} |
411 @end group | |
412 @end smallexample | |
413 | |
414 @cindex @file{lisp-mode.el} | |
415 The three Lisp modes (Lisp mode, Emacs Lisp mode, and Lisp | |
416 Interaction mode) have more features than Text mode and the code is | |
417 correspondingly more complicated. Here are excerpts from | |
418 @file{lisp-mode.el} that illustrate how these modes are written. | |
419 | |
420 @cindex syntax table example | |
421 @smallexample | |
422 @group | |
423 ;; @r{Create mode-specific table variables.} | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
424 (defvar lisp-mode-syntax-table nil "") |
6451 | 425 (defvar emacs-lisp-mode-syntax-table nil "") |
426 (defvar lisp-mode-abbrev-table nil "") | |
427 @end group | |
428 | |
429 @group | |
430 (if (not emacs-lisp-mode-syntax-table) ; @r{Do not change the table} | |
431 ; @r{if it is already set.} | |
432 (let ((i 0)) | |
433 (setq emacs-lisp-mode-syntax-table (make-syntax-table)) | |
434 @end group | |
435 | |
436 @group | |
437 ;; @r{Set syntax of chars up to 0 to class of chars that are} | |
438 ;; @r{part of symbol names but not words.} | |
52978
1a5c50faf357
Replace @sc{foo} with @acronym{FOO}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
52956
diff
changeset
|
439 ;; @r{(The number 0 is @code{48} in the @acronym{ASCII} character set.)} |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
440 (while (< i ?0) |
6451 | 441 (modify-syntax-entry i "_ " emacs-lisp-mode-syntax-table) |
442 (setq i (1+ i))) | |
443 @dots{} | |
444 @end group | |
445 @group | |
446 ;; @r{Set the syntax for other characters.} | |
447 (modify-syntax-entry ? " " emacs-lisp-mode-syntax-table) | |
448 (modify-syntax-entry ?\t " " emacs-lisp-mode-syntax-table) | |
449 @dots{} | |
450 @end group | |
451 @group | |
452 (modify-syntax-entry ?\( "() " emacs-lisp-mode-syntax-table) | |
453 (modify-syntax-entry ?\) ")( " emacs-lisp-mode-syntax-table) | |
454 @dots{})) | |
455 ;; @r{Create an abbrev table for lisp-mode.} | |
456 (define-abbrev-table 'lisp-mode-abbrev-table ()) | |
457 @end group | |
458 @end smallexample | |
459 | |
460 Much code is shared among the three Lisp modes. The following | |
461 function sets various variables; it is called by each of the major Lisp | |
462 mode functions: | |
463 | |
464 @smallexample | |
465 @group | |
466 (defun lisp-mode-variables (lisp-syntax) | |
467 (cond (lisp-syntax | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
468 (set-syntax-table lisp-mode-syntax-table))) |
6451 | 469 (setq local-abbrev-table lisp-mode-abbrev-table) |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
470 @dots{} |
6451 | 471 @end group |
472 @end smallexample | |
473 | |
474 Functions such as @code{forward-paragraph} use the value of the | |
475 @code{paragraph-start} variable. Since Lisp code is different from | |
476 ordinary text, the @code{paragraph-start} variable needs to be set | |
477 specially to handle Lisp. Also, comments are indented in a special | |
478 fashion in Lisp and the Lisp modes need their own mode-specific | |
479 @code{comment-indent-function}. The code to set these variables is the | |
480 rest of @code{lisp-mode-variables}. | |
481 | |
482 @smallexample | |
483 @group | |
484 (make-local-variable 'paragraph-start) | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
485 (setq paragraph-start (concat page-delimiter "\\|$" )) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
486 (make-local-variable 'paragraph-separate) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
487 (setq paragraph-separate paragraph-start) |
6451 | 488 @dots{} |
489 @end group | |
490 @group | |
491 (make-local-variable 'comment-indent-function) | |
492 (setq comment-indent-function 'lisp-comment-indent)) | |
25875 | 493 @dots{} |
6451 | 494 @end group |
495 @end smallexample | |
496 | |
497 Each of the different Lisp modes has a slightly different keymap. For | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
498 example, Lisp mode binds @kbd{C-c C-z} to @code{run-lisp}, but the other |
6451 | 499 Lisp modes do not. However, all Lisp modes have some commands in |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
500 common. The following code sets up the common commands: |
6451 | 501 |
502 @smallexample | |
503 @group | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
504 (defvar shared-lisp-mode-map () |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
505 "Keymap for commands shared by all sorts of Lisp modes.") |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
506 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
507 (if shared-lisp-mode-map |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
508 () |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
509 (setq shared-lisp-mode-map (make-sparse-keymap)) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
510 (define-key shared-lisp-mode-map "\e\C-q" 'indent-sexp) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
511 (define-key shared-lisp-mode-map "\177" |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
512 'backward-delete-char-untabify)) |
6451 | 513 @end group |
514 @end smallexample | |
515 | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
516 @noindent |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
517 And here is the code to set up the keymap for Lisp mode: |
6451 | 518 |
519 @smallexample | |
520 @group | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
521 (defvar lisp-mode-map () |
25950
7996385fc601
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
522 "Keymap for ordinary Lisp mode...") |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
523 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
524 (if lisp-mode-map |
6451 | 525 () |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
526 (setq lisp-mode-map (make-sparse-keymap)) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
527 (set-keymap-parent lisp-mode-map shared-lisp-mode-map) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
528 (define-key lisp-mode-map "\e\C-x" 'lisp-eval-defun) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
529 (define-key lisp-mode-map "\C-c\C-z" 'run-lisp)) |
6451 | 530 @end group |
531 @end smallexample | |
532 | |
533 Finally, here is the complete major mode function definition for | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
534 Lisp mode. |
6451 | 535 |
536 @smallexample | |
537 @group | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
538 (defun lisp-mode () |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
539 "Major mode for editing Lisp code for Lisps other than GNU Emacs Lisp. |
6451 | 540 Commands: |
541 Delete converts tabs to spaces as it moves back. | |
542 Blank lines separate paragraphs. Semicolons start comments. | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
543 \\@{lisp-mode-map@} |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
544 Note that `run-lisp' may be used either to start an inferior Lisp job |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
545 or to switch back to an existing one. |
6451 | 546 @end group |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
547 |
6451 | 548 @group |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
549 Entry to this mode calls the value of `lisp-mode-hook' |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
550 if that value is non-nil." |
6451 | 551 (interactive) |
552 (kill-all-local-variables) | |
553 @end group | |
554 @group | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
555 (use-local-map lisp-mode-map) ; @r{Select the mode's keymap.} |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
556 (setq major-mode 'lisp-mode) ; @r{This is how @code{describe-mode}} |
6451 | 557 ; @r{finds out what to describe.} |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
558 (setq mode-name "Lisp") ; @r{This goes into the mode line.} |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
559 (lisp-mode-variables t) ; @r{This defines various variables.} |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
560 @end group |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
561 @group |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
562 (setq imenu-case-fold-search t) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
563 (set-syntax-table lisp-mode-syntax-table) |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
564 (run-mode-hooks 'lisp-mode-hook)) ; @r{This permits the user to use a} |
6451 | 565 ; @r{hook to customize the mode.} |
566 @end group | |
567 @end smallexample | |
568 | |
569 @node Auto Major Mode | |
570 @subsection How Emacs Chooses a Major Mode | |
571 | |
572 Based on information in the file name or in the file itself, Emacs | |
573 automatically selects a major mode for the new buffer when a file is | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
574 visited. It also processes local variables specified in the file text. |
6451 | 575 |
576 @deffn Command fundamental-mode | |
577 Fundamental mode is a major mode that is not specialized for anything | |
578 in particular. Other major modes are defined in effect by comparison | |
579 with this one---their definitions say what to change, starting from | |
580 Fundamental mode. The @code{fundamental-mode} function does @emph{not} | |
57213
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
581 run any mode hooks; you're not supposed to customize it. (If you want Emacs |
6451 | 582 to behave differently in Fundamental mode, change the @emph{global} |
583 state of Emacs.) | |
584 @end deffn | |
585 | |
586 @deffn Command normal-mode &optional find-file | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
587 This function establishes the proper major mode and buffer-local variable |
6451 | 588 bindings for the current buffer. First it calls @code{set-auto-mode}, |
589 then it runs @code{hack-local-variables} to parse, and bind or | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
590 evaluate as appropriate, the file's local variables. |
6451 | 591 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
592 If the @var{find-file} argument to @code{normal-mode} is non-@code{nil}, |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
593 @code{normal-mode} assumes that the @code{find-file} function is calling |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
594 it. In this case, it may process a local variables list at the end of |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
595 the file and in the @samp{-*-} line. The variable |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
596 @code{enable-local-variables} controls whether to do so. @xref{File |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
597 variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
598 the syntax of the local variables section of a file. |
6451 | 599 |
12098 | 600 If you run @code{normal-mode} interactively, the argument |
6451 | 601 @var{find-file} is normally @code{nil}. In this case, |
602 @code{normal-mode} unconditionally processes any local variables list. | |
603 | |
604 @cindex file mode specification error | |
12098 | 605 @code{normal-mode} uses @code{condition-case} around the call to the |
6451 | 606 major mode function, so errors are caught and reported as a @samp{File |
607 mode specification error}, followed by the original error message. | |
608 @end deffn | |
609 | |
610 @defun set-auto-mode | |
611 @cindex visited file mode | |
612 This function selects the major mode that is appropriate for the | |
613 current buffer. It may base its decision on the value of the @w{@samp{-*-}} | |
12888 | 614 line, on the visited file name (using @code{auto-mode-alist}), on the |
615 @w{@samp{#!}} line (using @code{interpreter-mode-alist}), or on the | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
616 file's local variables list. However, this function does not look for |
6451 | 617 the @samp{mode:} local variable near the end of a file; the |
618 @code{hack-local-variables} function does that. @xref{Choosing Modes, , | |
619 How Major Modes are Chosen, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}. | |
620 @end defun | |
621 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
622 @defopt default-major-mode |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
623 This variable holds the default major mode for new buffers. The |
6451 | 624 standard value is @code{fundamental-mode}. |
625 | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
626 If the value of @code{default-major-mode} is @code{nil}, Emacs uses |
6451 | 627 the (previously) current buffer's major mode for the major mode of a new |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
628 buffer. However, if that major mode symbol has a @code{mode-class} |
6451 | 629 property with value @code{special}, then it is not used for new buffers; |
630 Fundamental mode is used instead. The modes that have this property are | |
631 those such as Dired and Rmail that are useful only with text that has | |
632 been specially prepared. | |
633 @end defopt | |
634 | |
12067 | 635 @defun set-buffer-major-mode buffer |
636 This function sets the major mode of @var{buffer} to the value of | |
637 @code{default-major-mode}. If that variable is @code{nil}, it uses | |
638 the current buffer's major mode (if that is suitable). | |
639 | |
640 The low-level primitives for creating buffers do not use this function, | |
12098 | 641 but medium-level commands such as @code{switch-to-buffer} and |
642 @code{find-file-noselect} use it whenever they create buffers. | |
12067 | 643 @end defun |
644 | |
6451 | 645 @defvar initial-major-mode |
646 @cindex @samp{*scratch*} | |
647 The value of this variable determines the major mode of the initial | |
648 @samp{*scratch*} buffer. The value should be a symbol that is a major | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
649 mode command. The default value is @code{lisp-interaction-mode}. |
6451 | 650 @end defvar |
651 | |
652 @defvar auto-mode-alist | |
653 This variable contains an association list of file name patterns | |
654 (regular expressions; @pxref{Regular Expressions}) and corresponding | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
655 major mode commands. Usually, the file name patterns test for suffixes, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
656 such as @samp{.el} and @samp{.c}, but this need not be the case. An |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
657 ordinary element of the alist looks like @code{(@var{regexp} . |
6451 | 658 @var{mode-function})}. |
659 | |
660 For example, | |
661 | |
662 @smallexample | |
663 @group | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
664 (("\\`/tmp/fol/" . text-mode) |
8505
d3f7cadf8c95
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
8016
diff
changeset
|
665 ("\\.texinfo\\'" . texinfo-mode) |
d3f7cadf8c95
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
8016
diff
changeset
|
666 ("\\.texi\\'" . texinfo-mode) |
6451 | 667 @end group |
668 @group | |
8505
d3f7cadf8c95
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
8016
diff
changeset
|
669 ("\\.el\\'" . emacs-lisp-mode) |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
670 ("\\.c\\'" . c-mode) |
8505
d3f7cadf8c95
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
8016
diff
changeset
|
671 ("\\.h\\'" . c-mode) |
6451 | 672 @dots{}) |
673 @end group | |
674 @end smallexample | |
675 | |
676 When you visit a file whose expanded file name (@pxref{File Name | |
677 Expansion}) matches a @var{regexp}, @code{set-auto-mode} calls the | |
678 corresponding @var{mode-function}. This feature enables Emacs to select | |
679 the proper major mode for most files. | |
680 | |
681 If an element of @code{auto-mode-alist} has the form @code{(@var{regexp} | |
682 @var{function} t)}, then after calling @var{function}, Emacs searches | |
683 @code{auto-mode-alist} again for a match against the portion of the file | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
684 name that did not match before. This feature is useful for |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
685 uncompression packages: an entry of the form @code{("\\.gz\\'" |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
686 @var{function} t)} can uncompress the file and then put the uncompressed |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
687 file in the proper mode according to the name sans @samp{.gz}. |
6451 | 688 |
689 Here is an example of how to prepend several pattern pairs to | |
690 @code{auto-mode-alist}. (You might use this sort of expression in your | |
25875 | 691 init file.) |
6451 | 692 |
693 @smallexample | |
694 @group | |
695 (setq auto-mode-alist | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
696 (append |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
697 ;; @r{File name (within directory) starts with a dot.} |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
698 '(("/\\.[^/]*\\'" . fundamental-mode) |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
699 ;; @r{File name has no dot.} |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
700 ("[^\\./]*\\'" . fundamental-mode) |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
701 ;; @r{File name ends in @samp{.C}.} |
8505
d3f7cadf8c95
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
8016
diff
changeset
|
702 ("\\.C\\'" . c++-mode)) |
6451 | 703 auto-mode-alist)) |
704 @end group | |
705 @end smallexample | |
706 @end defvar | |
707 | |
708 @defvar interpreter-mode-alist | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
709 This variable specifies major modes to use for scripts that specify a |
24934 | 710 command interpreter in a @samp{#!} line. Its value is a list of |
6451 | 711 elements of the form @code{(@var{interpreter} . @var{mode})}; for |
712 example, @code{("perl" . perl-mode)} is one element present by default. | |
713 The element says to use mode @var{mode} if the file specifies | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
714 an interpreter which matches @var{interpreter}. The value of |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
715 @var{interpreter} is actually a regular expression. |
6451 | 716 |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
717 This variable is applicable only when the @code{auto-mode-alist} does |
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
718 not indicate which major mode to use. |
6451 | 719 @end defvar |
720 | |
721 @node Mode Help | |
722 @subsection Getting Help about a Major Mode | |
723 @cindex mode help | |
724 @cindex help for major mode | |
725 @cindex documentation for major mode | |
726 | |
727 The @code{describe-mode} function is used to provide information | |
728 about major modes. It is normally called with @kbd{C-h m}. The | |
729 @code{describe-mode} function uses the value of @code{major-mode}, | |
730 which is why every major mode function needs to set the | |
731 @code{major-mode} variable. | |
732 | |
733 @deffn Command describe-mode | |
734 This function displays the documentation of the current major mode. | |
735 | |
736 The @code{describe-mode} function calls the @code{documentation} | |
737 function using the value of @code{major-mode} as an argument. Thus, it | |
738 displays the documentation string of the major mode function. | |
739 (@xref{Accessing Documentation}.) | |
740 @end deffn | |
741 | |
742 @defvar major-mode | |
743 This variable holds the symbol for the current buffer's major mode. | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
744 This symbol should have a function definition that is the command to |
6451 | 745 switch to that major mode. The @code{describe-mode} function uses the |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
746 documentation string of the function as the documentation of the major |
6451 | 747 mode. |
748 @end defvar | |
749 | |
750 @node Derived Modes | |
751 @subsection Defining Derived Modes | |
752 | |
753 It's often useful to define a new major mode in terms of an existing | |
754 one. An easy way to do this is to use @code{define-derived-mode}. | |
755 | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
756 @defmac define-derived-mode variant parent name docstring body@dots{} |
6451 | 757 This construct defines @var{variant} as a major mode command, using |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
758 @var{name} as the string form of the mode name. |
6451 | 759 |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
760 The new command @var{variant} is defined to call the function |
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
761 @var{parent}, then override certain aspects of that parent mode: |
6451 | 762 |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
763 @itemize @bullet |
6451 | 764 @item |
765 The new mode has its own keymap, named @code{@var{variant}-map}. | |
766 @code{define-derived-mode} initializes this map to inherit from | |
767 @code{@var{parent}-map}, if it is not already set. | |
768 | |
769 @item | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
770 The new mode has its own syntax table, kept in the variable |
6451 | 771 @code{@var{variant}-syntax-table}. |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
772 @code{define-derived-mode} initializes this variable by copying |
6451 | 773 @code{@var{parent}-syntax-table}, if it is not already set. |
774 | |
775 @item | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
776 The new mode has its own abbrev table, kept in the variable |
6451 | 777 @code{@var{variant}-abbrev-table}. |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
778 @code{define-derived-mode} initializes this variable by copying |
6451 | 779 @code{@var{parent}-abbrev-table}, if it is not already set. |
780 | |
781 @item | |
782 The new mode has its own mode hook, @code{@var{variant}-hook}, | |
783 which it runs in standard fashion as the very last thing that it does. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
784 (The new mode also runs the mode hook of @var{parent} as part |
6451 | 785 of calling @var{parent}.) |
786 @end itemize | |
787 | |
788 In addition, you can specify how to override other aspects of | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
789 @var{parent} with @var{body}. The command @var{variant} |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
790 evaluates the forms in @var{body} after setting up all its usual |
6451 | 791 overrides, just before running @code{@var{variant}-hook}. |
792 | |
793 The argument @var{docstring} specifies the documentation string for the | |
794 new mode. If you omit @var{docstring}, @code{define-derived-mode} | |
795 generates a documentation string. | |
796 | |
797 Here is a hypothetical example: | |
798 | |
799 @example | |
800 (define-derived-mode hypertext-mode | |
801 text-mode "Hypertext" | |
802 "Major mode for hypertext. | |
803 \\@{hypertext-mode-map@}" | |
804 (setq case-fold-search nil)) | |
805 | |
806 (define-key hypertext-mode-map | |
807 [down-mouse-3] 'do-hyper-link) | |
808 @end example | |
40928
ebfea94f75d4
Don't write explicit (interactive) in defining a derived mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39793
diff
changeset
|
809 |
ebfea94f75d4
Don't write explicit (interactive) in defining a derived mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39793
diff
changeset
|
810 Do not write an @code{interactive} spec in the definition; |
ebfea94f75d4
Don't write explicit (interactive) in defining a derived mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
39793
diff
changeset
|
811 @code{define-derived-mode} does that automatically. |
6451 | 812 @end defmac |
813 | |
57213
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
814 @node Mode Hooks |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
815 @subsection Mode Hooks |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
816 |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
817 The two last things a major mode function does is to run its mode |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
818 hook and finally the mode independent normal hook |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
819 @code{after-change-major-mode-hook}. If the major mode is a derived |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
820 mode, that is if it calls another major mode (the parent mode) in its |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
821 body, then the parent's mode hook is run just before the derived |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
822 mode's hook. Neither the parent's mode hook nor |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
823 @code{after-change-major-mode-hook} are run at the end of the actual |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
824 call to the parent mode. This applies recursively if the parent mode |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
825 has itself a parent. That is, the mode hooks of all major modes called |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
826 directly or indirectly by the major mode function are all run in |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
827 sequence at the end, just before @code{after-change-major-mode-hook}. |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
828 |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
829 If you are customizing a major mode, rather than defining one, the |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
830 above is all you need to know about the hooks run at the end of a |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
831 major mode. This also applies if you use @code{define-derived-mode} |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
832 to define a major mode, because that macro will automatically |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
833 implement the above for you. |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
834 |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
835 Programmers wishing to define a major mode without using |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
836 @code{define-derived-mode}, should make sure that their major mode |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
837 follows the above conventions. @xref{Major Mode Conventions}, for how |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
838 this should be accomplished. Below, we give some implementation |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
839 details. |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
840 |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
841 @defun run-mode-hooks &rest hookvars |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
842 Major modes should run their mode hook using this function. It is |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
843 similar to @code{run-hooks} (@pxref{Hooks}), but if run inside a |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
844 @code{delay-mode-hooks} form, this function does not run any hooks. |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
845 Instead, it arranges for @var{hookvars} to be run at a later call to |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
846 the function. Otherwise, @code{run-mode-hooks} runs any delayed hooks |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
847 in order, then @var{hookvars} and finally |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
848 @code{after-change-major-mode-hook}. |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
849 @end defun |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
850 |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
851 @defmac delay-mode-hooks body... |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
852 This macro executes @var{body} like @code{progn}, but all calls to |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
853 @code{run-mode-hooks} inside @var{body} delay running their hooks. |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
854 They will be run by the first call to @code{run-mode-hooks} after exit |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
855 from @code{delay-mode-hooks}. |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
856 @end defmac |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
857 |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
858 @defvar after-change-major-mode-hook |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
859 Every major mode function should run this normal hook at its very end. |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
860 It normally does not need to do so explicitly. Indeed, a major mode |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
861 function should normally run its mode hook with @code{run-mode-hooks} |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
862 as the very last thing it does and @code{run-mode-hooks} runs |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
863 @code{after-change-major-mode-hook} at its very end. |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
864 @end defvar |
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
865 |
6451 | 866 @node Minor Modes |
867 @section Minor Modes | |
868 @cindex minor mode | |
869 | |
870 A @dfn{minor mode} provides features that users may enable or disable | |
871 independently of the choice of major mode. Minor modes can be enabled | |
872 individually or in combination. Minor modes would be better named | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
873 ``generally available, optional feature modes,'' except that such a name |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
874 would be unwieldy. |
6451 | 875 |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
876 A minor mode is not usually meant as a variation of a single major mode. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
877 Usually they are general and can apply to many major modes. For |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
878 example, Auto Fill mode works with any major mode that permits text |
6451 | 879 insertion. To be general, a minor mode must be effectively independent |
880 of the things major modes do. | |
881 | |
882 A minor mode is often much more difficult to implement than a major | |
883 mode. One reason is that you should be able to activate and deactivate | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
884 minor modes in any order. A minor mode should be able to have its |
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
885 desired effect regardless of the major mode and regardless of the other |
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
886 minor modes in effect. |
6451 | 887 |
888 Often the biggest problem in implementing a minor mode is finding a | |
889 way to insert the necessary hook into the rest of Emacs. Minor mode | |
12098 | 890 keymaps make this easier than it used to be. |
6451 | 891 |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
892 @defvar minor-mode-list |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
893 The value of this variable is a list of all minor mode commands. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
894 @end defvar |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
895 |
6451 | 896 @menu |
897 * Minor Mode Conventions:: Tips for writing a minor mode. | |
898 * Keymaps and Minor Modes:: How a minor mode can have its own keymap. | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
899 * Defining Minor Modes:: A convenient facility for defining minor modes. |
6451 | 900 @end menu |
901 | |
902 @node Minor Mode Conventions | |
903 @subsection Conventions for Writing Minor Modes | |
904 @cindex minor mode conventions | |
905 @cindex conventions for writing minor modes | |
906 | |
907 There are conventions for writing minor modes just as there are for | |
908 major modes. Several of the major mode conventions apply to minor | |
909 modes as well: those regarding the name of the mode initialization | |
910 function, the names of global symbols, and the use of keymaps and | |
911 other tables. | |
912 | |
913 In addition, there are several conventions that are specific to | |
914 minor modes. | |
915 | |
916 @itemize @bullet | |
917 @item | |
918 @cindex mode variable | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
919 Make a variable whose name ends in @samp{-mode} to control the minor |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
920 mode. We call this the @dfn{mode variable}. The minor mode command |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
921 should set this variable (@code{nil} to disable; anything else to |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
922 enable). |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
923 |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
924 If possible, implement the mode so that setting the variable |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
925 automatically enables or disables the mode. Then the minor mode command |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
926 does not need to do anything except set the variable. |
6451 | 927 |
928 This variable is used in conjunction with the @code{minor-mode-alist} to | |
929 display the minor mode name in the mode line. It can also enable | |
930 or disable a minor mode keymap. Individual commands or hooks can also | |
931 check the variable's value. | |
932 | |
933 If you want the minor mode to be enabled separately in each buffer, | |
934 make the variable buffer-local. | |
935 | |
936 @item | |
937 Define a command whose name is the same as the mode variable. | |
938 Its job is to enable and disable the mode by setting the variable. | |
939 | |
940 The command should accept one optional argument. If the argument is | |
51794
8a7816e7f5bd
(Minor Mode Conventions): Specify only some kinds
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51703
diff
changeset
|
941 @code{nil}, it should toggle the mode (turn it on if it is off, and |
8a7816e7f5bd
(Minor Mode Conventions): Specify only some kinds
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51703
diff
changeset
|
942 off if it is on). It should turn the mode on if the argument is a |
8a7816e7f5bd
(Minor Mode Conventions): Specify only some kinds
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51703
diff
changeset
|
943 positive integer, the symbol @code{t}, or a list whose @sc{car} is one |
8a7816e7f5bd
(Minor Mode Conventions): Specify only some kinds
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51703
diff
changeset
|
944 of those. It should turn the mode off if the argument is a negative |
55831
3d0a4333d97a
(Minor Mode Conventions): (-) has no special meaning
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55687
diff
changeset
|
945 integer or zero, the symbol @code{-}, or a list whose @sc{car} is a |
3d0a4333d97a
(Minor Mode Conventions): (-) has no special meaning
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55687
diff
changeset
|
946 negative integer or zero. The meaning of other arguments is not |
3d0a4333d97a
(Minor Mode Conventions): (-) has no special meaning
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
55687
diff
changeset
|
947 specified. |
6451 | 948 |
12098 | 949 Here is an example taken from the definition of @code{transient-mark-mode}. |
950 It shows the use of @code{transient-mark-mode} as a variable that enables or | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
951 disables the mode's behavior, and also shows the proper way to toggle, |
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
952 enable or disable the minor mode based on the raw prefix argument value. |
6451 | 953 |
954 @smallexample | |
955 @group | |
12098 | 956 (setq transient-mark-mode |
957 (if (null arg) (not transient-mark-mode) | |
6451 | 958 (> (prefix-numeric-value arg) 0))) |
959 @end group | |
960 @end smallexample | |
961 | |
962 @item | |
963 Add an element to @code{minor-mode-alist} for each minor mode | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
964 (@pxref{Mode Line Variables}), if you want to indicate the minor mode in |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
965 the mode line. This element should be a list of the following form: |
6451 | 966 |
967 @smallexample | |
968 (@var{mode-variable} @var{string}) | |
969 @end smallexample | |
970 | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
971 Here @var{mode-variable} is the variable that controls enabling of the |
6451 | 972 minor mode, and @var{string} is a short string, starting with a space, |
973 to represent the mode in the mode line. These strings must be short so | |
974 that there is room for several of them at once. | |
975 | |
976 When you add an element to @code{minor-mode-alist}, use @code{assq} to | |
977 check for an existing element, to avoid duplication. For example: | |
978 | |
979 @smallexample | |
980 @group | |
25875 | 981 (unless (assq 'leif-mode minor-mode-alist) |
982 (setq minor-mode-alist | |
983 (cons '(leif-mode " Leif") minor-mode-alist))) | |
984 @end group | |
985 @end smallexample | |
986 | |
987 @noindent | |
988 or like this, using @code{add-to-list} (@pxref{Setting Variables}): | |
989 | |
990 @smallexample | |
991 @group | |
992 (add-to-list 'minor-mode-alist '(leif-mode " Leif")) | |
6451 | 993 @end group |
994 @end smallexample | |
995 @end itemize | |
996 | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
997 Global minor modes distributed with Emacs should if possible support |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
998 enabling and disabling via Custom (@pxref{Customization}). To do this, |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
999 the first step is to define the mode variable with @code{defcustom}, and |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1000 specify @code{:type boolean}. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1001 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1002 If just setting the variable is not sufficient to enable the mode, you |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1003 should also specify a @code{:set} method which enables the mode by |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1004 invoke the mode command. Note in the variable's documentation string that |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1005 setting the variable other than via Custom may not take effect. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1006 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1007 Also mark the definition with an autoload cookie (@pxref{Autoload}), |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1008 and specify a @code{:require} so that customizing the variable will load |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1009 the library that defines the mode. This will copy suitable definitions |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1010 into @file{loaddefs.el} so that users can use @code{customize-option} to |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1011 enable the mode. For example: |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1012 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1013 @smallexample |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1014 @group |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1015 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1016 ;;;###autoload |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1017 (defcustom msb-mode nil |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1018 "Toggle msb-mode. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1019 Setting this variable directly does not take effect; |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1020 use either \\[customize] or the function `msb-mode'." |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1021 :set (lambda (symbol value) |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1022 (msb-mode (or value 0))) |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1023 :initialize 'custom-initialize-default |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1024 :version "20.4" |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1025 :type 'boolean |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1026 :group 'msb |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1027 :require 'msb) |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1028 @end group |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1029 @end smallexample |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1030 |
6451 | 1031 @node Keymaps and Minor Modes |
1032 @subsection Keymaps and Minor Modes | |
1033 | |
12098 | 1034 Each minor mode can have its own keymap, which is active when the mode |
1035 is enabled. To set up a keymap for a minor mode, add an element to the | |
1036 alist @code{minor-mode-map-alist}. @xref{Active Keymaps}. | |
6451 | 1037 |
1038 @cindex @code{self-insert-command}, minor modes | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1039 One use of minor mode keymaps is to modify the behavior of certain |
6451 | 1040 self-inserting characters so that they do something else as well as |
1041 self-insert. In general, this is the only way to do that, since the | |
1042 facilities for customizing @code{self-insert-command} are limited to | |
1043 special cases (designed for abbrevs and Auto Fill mode). (Do not try | |
1044 substituting your own definition of @code{self-insert-command} for the | |
1045 standard one. The editor command loop handles this function specially.) | |
1046 | |
17278
8ed8412c1ce7
Document key binding conventions for major modes and minor modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16432
diff
changeset
|
1047 The key sequences bound in a minor mode should consist of @kbd{C-c} |
8ed8412c1ce7
Document key binding conventions for major modes and minor modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16432
diff
changeset
|
1048 followed by a punctuation character @emph{other than} @kbd{@{}, |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1049 @kbd{@}}, @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, @kbd{:}, and @kbd{;}. (Those few punctuation |
17278
8ed8412c1ce7
Document key binding conventions for major modes and minor modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16432
diff
changeset
|
1050 characters are reserved for major modes.) |
8ed8412c1ce7
Document key binding conventions for major modes and minor modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16432
diff
changeset
|
1051 |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
1052 @node Defining Minor Modes |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
1053 @subsection Defining Minor Modes |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1054 |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
1055 The macro @code{define-minor-mode} offers a convenient way of |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
1056 implementing a mode in one self-contained definition. It supports only |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1057 buffer-local minor modes, not global ones. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1058 |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1059 @defmac define-minor-mode mode doc [init-value [lighter [keymap keyword-args... body...]]] |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
1060 @tindex define-minor-mode |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1061 This macro defines a new minor mode whose name is @var{mode} (a |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1062 symbol). It defines a command named @var{mode} to toggle the minor |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
1063 mode, with @var{doc} as its documentation string. It also defines a |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
1064 variable named @var{mode}, which is set to @code{t} or @code{nil} by |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
1065 enabling or disabling the mode. The variable is initialized to |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
1066 @var{init-value}. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1067 |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1068 The string @var{lighter} says what to display in the mode line |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1069 when the mode is enabled; if it is @code{nil}, the mode is not displayed |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1070 in the mode line. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1071 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1072 The optional argument @var{keymap} specifies the keymap for the minor mode. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1073 It can be a variable name, whose value is the keymap, or it can be an alist |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1074 specifying bindings in this form: |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1075 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1076 @example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1077 (@var{key-sequence} . @var{definition}) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1078 @end example |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1079 |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1080 The @var{keyword-args} consist of keywords followed by corresponding |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1081 values. A few keywords have special meanings: |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1082 |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1083 @table @code |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1084 @item :global @var{global} |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1085 If non-@code{nil} specifies that the minor mode should be global. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1086 By default, minor modes are buffer-local. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1087 |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1088 @item :init-value @var{init-value} |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1089 This is equivalent to specifying @var{init-value} positionally. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1090 |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1091 @item :lighter @var{lighter} |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1092 This is equivalent to specifying @var{lighter} positionally. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1093 |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1094 @item :keymap @var{keymap} |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1095 This is equivalent to specifying @var{keymap} positionally. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1096 @end table |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1097 |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1098 Any other keyword arguments are passed passed directly to the |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1099 @code{defcustom} generated for the variable @var{mode}. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1100 |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1101 The command named @var{mode} finishes by executing the @var{body} forms, |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1102 if any, after it has performed the standard actions such as setting |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1103 the variable named @var{mode}. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1104 @end defmac |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1105 |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1106 @findex easy-mmode-define-minor-mode |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1107 The name @code{easy-mmode-define-minor-mode} is an alias |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1108 for this macro. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1109 |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
1110 Here is an example of using @code{define-minor-mode}: |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1111 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1112 @smallexample |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
1113 (define-minor-mode hungry-mode |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1114 "Toggle Hungry mode. |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
1115 With no argument, this command toggles the mode. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1116 Non-null prefix argument turns on the mode. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1117 Null prefix argument turns off the mode. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1118 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1119 When Hungry mode is enabled, the control delete key |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1120 gobbles all preceding whitespace except the last. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1121 See the command \\[hungry-electric-delete]." |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1122 ;; The initial value. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1123 nil |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1124 ;; The indicator for the mode line. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1125 " Hungry" |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1126 ;; The minor mode bindings. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1127 '(("\C-\^?" . hungry-electric-delete) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1128 ("\C-\M-\^?" |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
1129 . (lambda () |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1130 (interactive) |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1131 (hungry-electric-delete t)))) |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1132 :group 'hunger) |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1133 @end smallexample |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1134 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1135 @noindent |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1136 This defines a minor mode named ``Hungry mode'', a command named |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1137 @code{hungry-mode} to toggle it, a variable named @code{hungry-mode} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1138 which indicates whether the mode is enabled, and a variable named |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1139 @code{hungry-mode-map} which holds the keymap that is active when the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1140 mode is enabled. It initializes the keymap with key bindings for |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1141 @kbd{C-@key{DEL}} and @kbd{C-M-@key{DEL}}. It puts the variable |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1142 @code{hungry-mode} into custom group @code{hunger}. There are no |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1143 @var{body} forms---many minor modes don't need any. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1144 |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1145 Here's an equivalent way to write it: |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1146 |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1147 @smallexample |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1148 (define-minor-mode hungry-mode |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1149 "Toggle Hungry mode. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1150 With no argument, this command toggles the mode. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1151 Non-null prefix argument turns on the mode. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1152 Null prefix argument turns off the mode. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1153 |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1154 When Hungry mode is enabled, the control delete key |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1155 gobbles all preceding whitespace except the last. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1156 See the command \\[hungry-electric-delete]." |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1157 ;; The initial value. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1158 :initial-value nil |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1159 ;; The indicator for the mode line. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1160 :lighter " Hungry" |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1161 ;; The minor mode bindings. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1162 :keymap |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1163 '(("\C-\^?" . hungry-electric-delete) |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1164 ("\C-\M-\^?" |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1165 . (lambda () |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1166 (interactive) |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1167 (hungry-electric-delete t)))) |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1168 :group 'hunger) |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
1169 @end smallexample |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
26211
diff
changeset
|
1170 |
6451 | 1171 @node Mode Line Format |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1172 @section Mode-Line Format |
6451 | 1173 @cindex mode line |
1174 | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1175 Each Emacs window (aside from minibuffer windows) typically has a mode |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1176 line at the bottom, which displays status information about the buffer |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1177 displayed in the window. The mode line contains information about the |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1178 buffer, such as its name, associated file, depth of recursive editing, |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1179 and major and minor modes. A window can also have a @dfn{header |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1180 line}, which is much like the mode line but appears at the top of the |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1181 window (starting in Emacs 21). |
6451 | 1182 |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1183 This section describes how to control the contents of the mode line |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1184 and header line. We include it in this chapter because much of the |
6451 | 1185 information displayed in the mode line relates to the enabled major and |
1186 minor modes. | |
1187 | |
1188 @code{mode-line-format} is a buffer-local variable that holds a | |
1189 template used to display the mode line of the current buffer. All | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1190 windows for the same buffer use the same @code{mode-line-format}, so |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1191 their mode lines appear the same---except for scrolling percentages, and |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1192 line and column numbers, since those depend on point and on how the |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1193 window is scrolled. @code{header-line-format} is used likewise for |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1194 header lines. |
6451 | 1195 |
42296
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1196 For efficiency, Emacs does not recompute the mode line and header |
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1197 line of a window in every redisplay. It does so when circumstances |
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1198 appear to call for it---for instance, if you change the window |
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1199 configuration, switch buffers, narrow or widen the buffer, scroll, or |
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1200 change the buffer's modification status. If you modify any of the |
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1201 variables referenced by @code{mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line |
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1202 Variables}), or any other variables and data structures that affect |
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1203 how text is displayed (@pxref{Display}), you may want to force an |
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1204 update of the mode line so as to display the new information or |
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1205 display it in the new way. |
6451 | 1206 |
1207 @c Emacs 19 feature | |
52859
bc7fbf233421
(Mode Line Format): Mention force-mode-line-update's argument.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52841
diff
changeset
|
1208 @defun force-mode-line-update &optional all |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1209 Force redisplay of the current buffer's mode line and header line. |
42296
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1210 The next redisplay will update the mode line and header line based on |
52859
bc7fbf233421
(Mode Line Format): Mention force-mode-line-update's argument.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52841
diff
changeset
|
1211 the latest values of all relevant variables. With optional |
bc7fbf233421
(Mode Line Format): Mention force-mode-line-update's argument.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52841
diff
changeset
|
1212 non-@code{nil} @var{all}, force redisplay of all mode lines and header |
bc7fbf233421
(Mode Line Format): Mention force-mode-line-update's argument.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52841
diff
changeset
|
1213 lines. |
42296
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1214 |
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1215 This function also forces recomputation of the menu bar menus |
7b9a0bcca3c2
Explain mode line redisplay better.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41938
diff
changeset
|
1216 and the frame title. |
6451 | 1217 @end defun |
1218 | |
1219 The mode line is usually displayed in inverse video; see | |
1220 @code{mode-line-inverse-video} in @ref{Inverse Video}. | |
1221 | |
42866
03dd2df2b595
(Mode Line Format): Short windows can suppress the mode line and header line.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
42296
diff
changeset
|
1222 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode |
03dd2df2b595
(Mode Line Format): Short windows can suppress the mode line and header line.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
42296
diff
changeset
|
1223 line or a header line, even if the variables call for one. A window |
03dd2df2b595
(Mode Line Format): Short windows can suppress the mode line and header line.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
42296
diff
changeset
|
1224 that is two lines tall cannot display both a mode line and a header |
03dd2df2b595
(Mode Line Format): Short windows can suppress the mode line and header line.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
42296
diff
changeset
|
1225 line at once; if the variables call for both, only the mode line |
03dd2df2b595
(Mode Line Format): Short windows can suppress the mode line and header line.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
42296
diff
changeset
|
1226 actually appears. |
03dd2df2b595
(Mode Line Format): Short windows can suppress the mode line and header line.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
42296
diff
changeset
|
1227 |
6451 | 1228 @menu |
1229 * Mode Line Data:: The data structure that controls the mode line. | |
1230 * Mode Line Variables:: Variables used in that data structure. | |
1231 * %-Constructs:: Putting information into a mode line. | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1232 * Properties in Mode:: Using text properties in the mode line. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1233 * Header Lines:: Like a mode line, but at the top. |
52197
a0b65ecec014
*** empty log message ***
John Paul Wallington <jpw@pobox.com>
parents:
52195
diff
changeset
|
1234 * Emulating Mode Line:: Formatting text as the mode line would. |
6451 | 1235 @end menu |
1236 | |
1237 @node Mode Line Data | |
1238 @subsection The Data Structure of the Mode Line | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1239 @cindex mode-line construct |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1240 |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1241 The mode-line contents are controlled by a data structure of lists, |
25875 | 1242 strings, symbols, and numbers kept in buffer-local variables. The data |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1243 structure is called a @dfn{mode-line construct}, and it is built in |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1244 recursive fashion out of simpler mode-line constructs. The same data |
25875 | 1245 structure is used for constructing frame titles (@pxref{Frame Titles}) |
1246 and header lines (@pxref{Header Lines}). | |
6451 | 1247 |
1248 @defvar mode-line-format | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1249 The value of this variable is a mode-line construct with overall |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1250 responsibility for the mode-line format. The value of this variable |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1251 controls which other variables are used to form the mode-line text, and |
6451 | 1252 where they appear. |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1253 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1254 If you set this variable to @code{nil} in a buffer, that buffer does not |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1255 have a mode line. (This feature was added in Emacs 21.) |
6451 | 1256 @end defvar |
1257 | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1258 A mode-line construct may be as simple as a fixed string of text, but |
6451 | 1259 it usually specifies how to use other variables to construct the text. |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1260 Many of these variables are themselves defined to have mode-line |
6451 | 1261 constructs as their values. |
1262 | |
1263 The default value of @code{mode-line-format} incorporates the values | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1264 of variables such as @code{mode-line-position} and |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1265 @code{mode-line-modes} (which in turn incorporates the values of the |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1266 variables @code{mode-name} and @code{minor-mode-alist}). Because of |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1267 this, very few modes need to alter @code{mode-line-format} itself. For |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1268 most purposes, it is sufficient to alter some of the variables that |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1269 @code{mode-line-format} either directly or indirectly refers to. |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1270 |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1271 A mode-line construct may be a list, a symbol, or a string. If the |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1272 value is a list, each element may be a list, a symbol, or a string. |
6451 | 1273 |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1274 The mode line can display various faces, if the strings that control |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1275 it have the @code{face} property. @xref{Properties in Mode}. In |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1276 addition, the face @code{mode-line} is used as a default for the whole |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1277 mode line (@pxref{Standard Faces}). |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1278 |
6451 | 1279 @table @code |
1280 @cindex percent symbol in mode line | |
1281 @item @var{string} | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1282 A string as a mode-line construct is displayed verbatim in the mode line |
12098 | 1283 except for @dfn{@code{%}-constructs}. Decimal digits after the @samp{%} |
6451 | 1284 specify the field width for space filling on the right (i.e., the data |
1285 is left justified). @xref{%-Constructs}. | |
1286 | |
1287 @item @var{symbol} | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1288 A symbol as a mode-line construct stands for its value. The value of |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1289 @var{symbol} is used as a mode-line construct, in place of @var{symbol}. |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1290 However, the symbols @code{t} and @code{nil} are ignored, as is any |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1291 symbol whose value is void. |
6451 | 1292 |
1293 There is one exception: if the value of @var{symbol} is a string, it is | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1294 displayed verbatim: the @code{%}-constructs are not recognized. |
6451 | 1295 |
52663
5f70316d2ec5
(Mode Line Data): Explain when symbols in mode-line
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52628
diff
changeset
|
1296 Unless @var{symbol} is marked as ``risky'' (i.e., it has a |
5f70316d2ec5
(Mode Line Data): Explain when symbols in mode-line
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52628
diff
changeset
|
1297 non-@code{nil} @code{risky-local-variable} property), all properties in |
5f70316d2ec5
(Mode Line Data): Explain when symbols in mode-line
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52628
diff
changeset
|
1298 any strings, as well as all @code{:eval} and @code{:propertize} forms in |
5f70316d2ec5
(Mode Line Data): Explain when symbols in mode-line
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52628
diff
changeset
|
1299 the value of that symbol will be ignored. |
5f70316d2ec5
(Mode Line Data): Explain when symbols in mode-line
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52628
diff
changeset
|
1300 |
6451 | 1301 @item (@var{string} @var{rest}@dots{}) @r{or} (@var{list} @var{rest}@dots{}) |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1302 A list whose first element is a string or list means to process all the |
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1303 elements recursively and concatenate the results. This is the most |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1304 common form of mode-line construct. |
6451 | 1305 |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1306 @item (:eval @var{form}) |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1307 A list whose first element is the symbol @code{:eval} says to evaluate |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1308 @var{form}, and use the result as a string to display. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1309 (This feature is new as of Emacs 21.) |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1310 |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1311 @item (:propertize @var{elt} @var{props}@dots{}) |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1312 A list whose first element is the symbol @code{:propertize} says to |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1313 process the mode-line construct @var{elt} recursively and add the text |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1314 properties specified by @var{props} to the result. The argument |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1315 @var{props} should consist of zero or more pairs @var{text-property} |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1316 @var{value}. (This feature is new as of Emacs 21.4.) |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1317 @c FIXME: This might be Emacs 21.5. |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1318 |
6451 | 1319 @item (@var{symbol} @var{then} @var{else}) |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1320 A list whose first element is a symbol that is not a keyword specifies a |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1321 conditional. Its meaning depends on the value of @var{symbol}. If the |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1322 value is non-@code{nil}, the second element, @var{then}, is processed |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1323 recursively as a mode-line element. But if the value of @var{symbol} is |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1324 @code{nil}, the third element, @var{else}, is processed recursively. |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1325 You may omit @var{else}; then the mode-line element displays nothing if |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1326 the value of @var{symbol} is @code{nil}. |
6451 | 1327 |
1328 @item (@var{width} @var{rest}@dots{}) | |
1329 A list whose first element is an integer specifies truncation or | |
1330 padding of the results of @var{rest}. The remaining elements | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1331 @var{rest} are processed recursively as mode-line constructs and |
6451 | 1332 concatenated together. Then the result is space filled (if |
1333 @var{width} is positive) or truncated (to @minus{}@var{width} columns, | |
1334 if @var{width} is negative) on the right. | |
1335 | |
1336 For example, the usual way to show what percentage of a buffer is above | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1337 the top of the window is to use a list like this: @code{(-3 "%p")}. |
6451 | 1338 @end table |
1339 | |
1340 If you do alter @code{mode-line-format} itself, the new value should | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1341 use the same variables that appear in the default value (@pxref{Mode |
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1342 Line Variables}), rather than duplicating their contents or displaying |
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1343 the information in another fashion. This way, customizations made by |
12098 | 1344 the user or by Lisp programs (such as @code{display-time} and major |
1345 modes) via changes to those variables remain effective. | |
6451 | 1346 |
1347 @cindex Shell mode @code{mode-line-format} | |
1348 Here is an example of a @code{mode-line-format} that might be | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1349 useful for @code{shell-mode}, since it contains the host name and default |
6451 | 1350 directory. |
1351 | |
1352 @example | |
1353 @group | |
1354 (setq mode-line-format | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1355 (list "-" |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1356 'mode-line-mule-info |
6451 | 1357 'mode-line-modified |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1358 'mode-line-frame-identification |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
1359 "%b--" |
6451 | 1360 @end group |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1361 @group |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1362 ;; @r{Note that this is evaluated while making the list.} |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1363 ;; @r{It makes a mode-line construct which is just a string.} |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1364 (getenv "HOST") |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1365 @end group |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
1366 ":" |
6451 | 1367 'default-directory |
1368 " " | |
1369 'global-mode-string | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1370 " %[(" |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1371 '(:eval (mode-line-mode-name)) |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
1372 'mode-line-process |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
1373 'minor-mode-alist |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
1374 "%n" |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1375 ")%]--" |
6451 | 1376 @group |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1377 '(which-func-mode ("" which-func-format "--")) |
12098 | 1378 '(line-number-mode "L%l--") |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1379 '(column-number-mode "C%c--") |
52663
5f70316d2ec5
(Mode Line Data): Explain when symbols in mode-line
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52628
diff
changeset
|
1380 '(-3 "%p") |
6451 | 1381 "-%-")) |
1382 @end group | |
1383 @end example | |
1384 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1385 @noindent |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1386 (The variables @code{line-number-mode}, @code{column-number-mode} |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1387 and @code{which-func-mode} enable particular minor modes; as usual, |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1388 these variable names are also the minor mode command names.) |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1389 |
6451 | 1390 @node Mode Line Variables |
1391 @subsection Variables Used in the Mode Line | |
1392 | |
1393 This section describes variables incorporated by the | |
1394 standard value of @code{mode-line-format} into the text of the mode | |
1395 line. There is nothing inherently special about these variables; any | |
1396 other variables could have the same effects on the mode line if | |
1397 @code{mode-line-format} were changed to use them. | |
1398 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1399 @defvar mode-line-mule-info |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1400 This variable holds the value of the mode-line construct that displays |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1401 information about the language environment, buffer coding system, and |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1402 current input method. @xref{Non-ASCII Characters}. |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1403 @end defvar |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1404 |
6451 | 1405 @defvar mode-line-modified |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1406 This variable holds the value of the mode-line construct that displays |
6451 | 1407 whether the current buffer is modified. |
1408 | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1409 The default value of @code{mode-line-modified} is @code{("%1*%1+")}. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1410 This means that the mode line displays @samp{**} if the buffer is |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1411 modified, @samp{--} if the buffer is not modified, @samp{%%} if the |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1412 buffer is read only, and @samp{%*} if the buffer is read only and |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1413 modified. |
6451 | 1414 |
1415 Changing this variable does not force an update of the mode line. | |
1416 @end defvar | |
1417 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1418 @defvar mode-line-frame-identification |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1419 This variable identifies the current frame. The default value is |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1420 @code{" "} if you are using a window system which can show multiple |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1421 frames, or @code{"-%F "} on an ordinary terminal which shows only one |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1422 frame at a time. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1423 @end defvar |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1424 |
6451 | 1425 @defvar mode-line-buffer-identification |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1426 This variable identifies the buffer being displayed in the window. Its |
22267
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1427 default value is @code{("%12b")}, which displays the buffer name, padded |
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1428 with spaces to at least 12 columns. |
6451 | 1429 @end defvar |
1430 | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1431 @defvar mode-line-position |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1432 This variable indicates the position in the buffer. Here is a |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1433 simplified version of its default value. The actual default value |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1434 also specifies addition of the @code{help-echo} text property. |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1435 |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1436 @example |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1437 @group |
52663
5f70316d2ec5
(Mode Line Data): Explain when symbols in mode-line
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52628
diff
changeset
|
1438 ((-3 "%p") |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1439 (size-indication-mode (8 " of %I")) |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1440 @end group |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1441 @group |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1442 (line-number-mode |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1443 ((column-number-mode |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1444 (10 " (%l,%c)") |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1445 (6 " L%l"))) |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1446 ((column-number-mode |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1447 (5 " C%c"))))) |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1448 @end group |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1449 @end example |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1450 |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1451 This means that @code{mode-line-position} displays at least the buffer |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1452 percentage and possibly the buffer size, the line number and the column |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1453 number. |
6451 | 1454 @end defvar |
1455 | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1456 @defvar vc-mode |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1457 The variable @code{vc-mode}, buffer-local in each buffer, records |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1458 whether the buffer's visited file is maintained with version control, |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1459 and, if so, which kind. Its value is a string that appears in the mode |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1460 line, or @code{nil} for no version control. |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1461 @end defvar |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1462 |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1463 @defvar mode-line-modes |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1464 This variable displays the buffer's major and minor modes. Here is a |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1465 simplified version of its default value. The real default value also |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1466 specifies addition of text properties. |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1467 |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1468 @example |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1469 @group |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1470 ("%[(" mode-name |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1471 mode-line-process minor-mode-alist |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1472 "%n" ")%]--") |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1473 @end group |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1474 @end example |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1475 |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1476 So @code{mode-line-modes} normally also displays the recursive editing |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1477 level, information on the process status and whether narrowing is in |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1478 effect. |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1479 @end defvar |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1480 |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1481 The following three variables are used in @code{mode-line-modes}: |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1482 |
6451 | 1483 @defvar mode-name |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1484 This buffer-local variable holds the ``pretty'' name of the current |
6451 | 1485 buffer's major mode. Each major mode should set this variable so that the |
1486 mode name will appear in the mode line. | |
1487 @end defvar | |
1488 | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1489 @defvar mode-line-process |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1490 This buffer-local variable contains the mode-line information on process |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1491 status in modes used for communicating with subprocesses. It is |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1492 displayed immediately following the major mode name, with no intervening |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1493 space. For example, its value in the @samp{*shell*} buffer is |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1494 @code{(":%s")}, which allows the shell to display its status along |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1495 with the major mode as: @samp{(Shell:run)}. Normally this variable |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1496 is @code{nil}. |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1497 @end defvar |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1498 |
6451 | 1499 @defvar minor-mode-alist |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1500 This variable holds an association list whose elements specify how the |
6451 | 1501 mode line should indicate that a minor mode is active. Each element of |
1502 the @code{minor-mode-alist} should be a two-element list: | |
1503 | |
1504 @example | |
1505 (@var{minor-mode-variable} @var{mode-line-string}) | |
1506 @end example | |
1507 | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1508 More generally, @var{mode-line-string} can be any mode-line spec. It |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1509 appears in the mode line when the value of @var{minor-mode-variable} |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1510 is non-@code{nil}, and not otherwise. These strings should begin with |
6451 | 1511 spaces so that they don't run together. Conventionally, the |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1512 @var{minor-mode-variable} for a specific mode is set to a |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1513 non-@code{nil} value when that minor mode is activated. |
6451 | 1514 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1515 @code{minor-mode-alist} itself is not buffer-local. Each variable |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1516 mentioned in the alist should be buffer-local if its minor mode can be |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1517 enabled separately in each buffer. |
6451 | 1518 @end defvar |
1519 | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1520 @defvar global-mode-string |
55508
44124e158456
(Mode Line Variables): Fix description of global-mode-string, which is now after
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
55414
diff
changeset
|
1521 This variable holds a mode-line spec that, by default, appears in the |
44124e158456
(Mode Line Variables): Fix description of global-mode-string, which is now after
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
55414
diff
changeset
|
1522 mode line just after the @code{which-func-mode} minor mode if set, |
44124e158456
(Mode Line Variables): Fix description of global-mode-string, which is now after
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
55414
diff
changeset
|
1523 else after @code{mode-line-modes}. The command @code{display-time} |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1524 sets @code{global-mode-string} to refer to the variable |
55508
44124e158456
(Mode Line Variables): Fix description of global-mode-string, which is now after
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
55414
diff
changeset
|
1525 @code{display-time-string}, which holds a string containing the time |
44124e158456
(Mode Line Variables): Fix description of global-mode-string, which is now after
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
55414
diff
changeset
|
1526 and load information. |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1527 |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1528 The @samp{%M} construct substitutes the value of |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1529 @code{global-mode-string}, but that is obsolete, since the variable is |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1530 included in the mode line from @code{mode-line-format}. |
25875 | 1531 @end defvar |
1532 | |
1533 The variable @code{default-mode-line-format} is where | |
1534 @code{mode-line-format} usually gets its value: | |
1535 | |
6451 | 1536 @defvar default-mode-line-format |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1537 This variable holds the default @code{mode-line-format} for buffers |
6451 | 1538 that do not override it. This is the same as @code{(default-value |
1539 'mode-line-format)}. | |
1540 | |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1541 Here is a simplified version of the default value of |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1542 @code{default-mode-line-format}. The real default value also |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1543 specifies addition of text properties. |
6451 | 1544 |
1545 @example | |
1546 @group | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1547 ("-" |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1548 mode-line-mule-info |
6451 | 1549 mode-line-modified |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1550 mode-line-frame-identification |
6451 | 1551 mode-line-buffer-identification |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1552 @end group |
6451 | 1553 " " |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1554 mode-line-position |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1555 (vc-mode vc-mode) |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1556 " " |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1557 @group |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1558 mode-line-modes |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1559 (which-func-mode ("" which-func-format "--")) |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1560 (global-mode-string ("--" global-mode-string)) |
6451 | 1561 "-%-") |
1562 @end group | |
1563 @end example | |
1564 @end defvar | |
1565 | |
1566 @node %-Constructs | |
1567 @subsection @code{%}-Constructs in the Mode Line | |
1568 | |
1569 The following table lists the recognized @code{%}-constructs and what | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1570 they mean. In any construct except @samp{%%}, you can add a decimal |
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1571 integer after the @samp{%} to specify how many characters to display. |
6451 | 1572 |
1573 @table @code | |
1574 @item %b | |
1575 The current buffer name, obtained with the @code{buffer-name} function. | |
1576 @xref{Buffer Names}. | |
1577 | |
25875 | 1578 @item %c |
1579 The current column number of point. | |
1580 | |
6451 | 1581 @item %f |
1582 The visited file name, obtained with the @code{buffer-file-name} | |
1583 function. @xref{Buffer File Name}. | |
1584 | |
12067 | 1585 @item %F |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1586 The title (only on a window system) or the name of the selected frame. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1587 @xref{Window Frame Parameters}. |
12067 | 1588 |
52463
be54b19bb668
(%-Constructs): Document new `%i' and `%I' constructs.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
1589 @item %i |
be54b19bb668
(%-Constructs): Document new `%i' and `%I' constructs.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
1590 The size of the accessible part of the current buffer; basically |
be54b19bb668
(%-Constructs): Document new `%i' and `%I' constructs.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
1591 @code{(- (point-max) (point-min))}. |
be54b19bb668
(%-Constructs): Document new `%i' and `%I' constructs.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
1592 |
be54b19bb668
(%-Constructs): Document new `%i' and `%I' constructs.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
1593 @item %I |
be54b19bb668
(%-Constructs): Document new `%i' and `%I' constructs.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
1594 Like @samp{%i}, but the size is printed in a more readable way by using |
be54b19bb668
(%-Constructs): Document new `%i' and `%I' constructs.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
1595 @samp{k} for 10^3, @samp{M} for 10^6, @samp{G} for 10^9, etc., to |
be54b19bb668
(%-Constructs): Document new `%i' and `%I' constructs.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
1596 abbreviate. |
be54b19bb668
(%-Constructs): Document new `%i' and `%I' constructs.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
1597 |
12067 | 1598 @item %l |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1599 The current line number of point, counting within the accessible portion |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1600 of the buffer. |
12067 | 1601 |
25875 | 1602 @item %n |
1603 @samp{Narrow} when narrowing is in effect; nothing otherwise (see | |
1604 @code{narrow-to-region} in @ref{Narrowing}). | |
1605 | |
1606 @item %p | |
1607 The percentage of the buffer text above the @strong{top} of window, or | |
1608 @samp{Top}, @samp{Bottom} or @samp{All}. Note that the default | |
1609 mode-line specification truncates this to three characters. | |
1610 | |
1611 @item %P | |
1612 The percentage of the buffer text that is above the @strong{bottom} of | |
1613 the window (which includes the text visible in the window, as well as | |
1614 the text above the top), plus @samp{Top} if the top of the buffer is | |
1615 visible on screen; or @samp{Bottom} or @samp{All}. | |
1616 | |
1617 @item %s | |
1618 The status of the subprocess belonging to the current buffer, obtained with | |
1619 @code{process-status}. @xref{Process Information}. | |
1620 | |
1621 @item %t | |
1622 Whether the visited file is a text file or a binary file. This is a | |
1623 meaningful distinction only on certain operating systems (@pxref{MS-DOS | |
1624 File Types}). | |
1625 | |
6451 | 1626 @item %* |
1627 @samp{%} if the buffer is read only (see @code{buffer-read-only}); @* | |
1628 @samp{*} if the buffer is modified (see @code{buffer-modified-p}); @* | |
1629 @samp{-} otherwise. @xref{Buffer Modification}. | |
1630 | |
1631 @item %+ | |
12067 | 1632 @samp{*} if the buffer is modified (see @code{buffer-modified-p}); @* |
1633 @samp{%} if the buffer is read only (see @code{buffer-read-only}); @* | |
1634 @samp{-} otherwise. This differs from @samp{%*} only for a modified | |
1635 read-only buffer. @xref{Buffer Modification}. | |
1636 | |
1637 @item %& | |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
1638 @samp{*} if the buffer is modified, and @samp{-} otherwise. |
6451 | 1639 |
1640 @item %[ | |
1641 An indication of the depth of recursive editing levels (not counting | |
1642 minibuffer levels): one @samp{[} for each editing level. | |
1643 @xref{Recursive Editing}. | |
1644 | |
1645 @item %] | |
1646 One @samp{]} for each recursive editing level (not counting minibuffer | |
1647 levels). | |
1648 | |
25875 | 1649 @item %- |
1650 Dashes sufficient to fill the remainder of the mode line. | |
1651 | |
6451 | 1652 @item %% |
1653 The character @samp{%}---this is how to include a literal @samp{%} in a | |
1654 string in which @code{%}-constructs are allowed. | |
1655 @end table | |
1656 | |
1657 The following two @code{%}-constructs are still supported, but they are | |
1658 obsolete, since you can get the same results with the variables | |
1659 @code{mode-name} and @code{global-mode-string}. | |
1660 | |
1661 @table @code | |
1662 @item %m | |
1663 The value of @code{mode-name}. | |
1664 | |
1665 @item %M | |
1666 The value of @code{global-mode-string}. Currently, only | |
1667 @code{display-time} modifies the value of @code{global-mode-string}. | |
1668 @end table | |
1669 | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1670 @node Properties in Mode |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1671 @subsection Properties in the Mode Line |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1672 @cindex text properties in the mode line |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1673 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1674 Starting in Emacs 21, certain text properties are meaningful in the |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1675 mode line. The @code{face} property affects the appearance of text; the |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1676 @code{help-echo} property associate help strings with the text, and |
29102 | 1677 @code{local-map} can make the text mouse-sensitive. |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1678 |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1679 There are four ways to specify text properties for text in the mode |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1680 line: |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1681 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1682 @enumerate |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1683 @item |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1684 Put a string with a text property directly into the mode-line data |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1685 structure. |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1686 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1687 @item |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1688 Put a text property on a mode-line %-construct such as @samp{%12b}; then |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1689 the expansion of the %-construct will have that same text property. |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1690 |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1691 @item |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1692 Use a @code{(:propertize @var{elt} @var{props}@dots{})} construct to |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1693 give @var{elt} a text property specified by @var{props}. |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1694 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1695 @item |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1696 Use a list containing @code{:eval @var{form}} in the mode-line data |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1697 structure, and make @var{form} evaluate to a string that has a text |
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1698 property. |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1699 @end enumerate |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1700 |
29102 | 1701 You use the @code{local-map} property to specify a keymap. Like any |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1702 keymap, it can bind character keys and function keys; but that has no |
25875 | 1703 effect, since it is impossible to move point into the mode line. This |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1704 keymap can only take real effect for mouse clicks. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1705 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1706 @node Header Lines |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1707 @subsection Window Header Lines |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1708 @cindex header line (of a window) |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1709 @cindex window header line |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1710 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1711 Starting in Emacs 21, a window can have a @dfn{header line} at the |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1712 top, just as it can have a mode line at the bottom. The header line |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1713 feature works just like the mode-line feature, except that it's |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1714 controlled by different variables. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1715 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1716 @tindex header-line-format |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1717 @defvar header-line-format |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1718 This variable, local in every buffer, specifies how to display the |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1719 header line, for windows displaying the buffer. The format of the value |
26783 | 1720 is the same as for @code{mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Data}). |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1721 @end defvar |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1722 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1723 @tindex default-header-line-format |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1724 @defvar default-header-line-format |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1725 This variable holds the default @code{header-line-format} for buffers |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1726 that do not override it. This is the same as @code{(default-value |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1727 'header-line-format)}. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1728 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1729 It is normally @code{nil}, so that ordinary buffers have no header line. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1730 @end defvar |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
1731 |
52187
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1732 @node Emulating Mode Line |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1733 @subsection Emulating Mode-Line Formatting |
52187
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1734 |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1735 You can use the function @code{format-mode-line} to compute |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1736 the text that would appear in a mode line or header line |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
1737 based on certain mode-line specification. |
52187
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1738 |
59389
f1eb5a3ef974
(Emulating Mode Line): format-mode-line requires 1 arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59138
diff
changeset
|
1739 @defun format-mode-line format &optional window no-props buffer |
52187
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1740 This function formats a line of text according to @var{format} as if |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1741 it were generating the mode line for @var{window}, but instead of |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1742 displaying the text in the mode line or the header line, it returns |
59389
f1eb5a3ef974
(Emulating Mode Line): format-mode-line requires 1 arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59138
diff
changeset
|
1743 the text as a string. The argument @var{window} defaults to the |
f1eb5a3ef974
(Emulating Mode Line): format-mode-line requires 1 arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59138
diff
changeset
|
1744 selected window. If @var{buffer} is non-@code{nil}, all the |
f1eb5a3ef974
(Emulating Mode Line): format-mode-line requires 1 arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59138
diff
changeset
|
1745 information used is taken from @var{buffer}; by default, it comes from |
f1eb5a3ef974
(Emulating Mode Line): format-mode-line requires 1 arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59138
diff
changeset
|
1746 @var{window}'s buffer. |
52187
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1747 |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1748 The value string normally has text properties that correspond to the |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1749 faces, keymaps, etc., that the mode line would have. If |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1750 @var{no-props} is non-@code{nil}, the value has no text properties. |
59389
f1eb5a3ef974
(Emulating Mode Line): format-mode-line requires 1 arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59138
diff
changeset
|
1751 |
f1eb5a3ef974
(Emulating Mode Line): format-mode-line requires 1 arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59138
diff
changeset
|
1752 For example, @code{(format-mode-line header-line-format)} returns the |
f1eb5a3ef974
(Emulating Mode Line): format-mode-line requires 1 arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59138
diff
changeset
|
1753 text that would appear in the selected window's header line (@code{""} |
f1eb5a3ef974
(Emulating Mode Line): format-mode-line requires 1 arg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59138
diff
changeset
|
1754 if it has no header line). |
52187
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1755 @end defun |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
1756 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1757 @node Imenu |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1758 @section Imenu |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1759 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1760 @cindex Imenu |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1761 @dfn{Imenu} is a feature that lets users select a definition or |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1762 section in the buffer, from a menu which lists all of them, to go |
52001
b96d92c96bd1
(Imenu): Add xref to Emacs Manual node on Imenu.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51917
diff
changeset
|
1763 directly to that location in the buffer. Imenu works by constructing |
b96d92c96bd1
(Imenu): Add xref to Emacs Manual node on Imenu.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51917
diff
changeset
|
1764 a buffer index which lists the names and buffer positions of the |
25875 | 1765 definitions, or other named portions of the buffer; then the user can |
52001
b96d92c96bd1
(Imenu): Add xref to Emacs Manual node on Imenu.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51917
diff
changeset
|
1766 choose one of them and move point to it. The user-level commands for |
b96d92c96bd1
(Imenu): Add xref to Emacs Manual node on Imenu.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51917
diff
changeset
|
1767 using Imenu are described in the Emacs Manual (@pxref{Imenu,, Imenu, |
b96d92c96bd1
(Imenu): Add xref to Emacs Manual node on Imenu.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51917
diff
changeset
|
1768 emacs, the Emacs Manual}). This section explains how to customize |
b96d92c96bd1
(Imenu): Add xref to Emacs Manual node on Imenu.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51917
diff
changeset
|
1769 Imenu's method of finding definitions or buffer portions for a |
25875 | 1770 particular major mode. |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1771 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1772 The usual and simplest way is to set the variable |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1773 @code{imenu-generic-expression}: |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1774 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1775 @defvar imenu-generic-expression |
52744
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1776 This variable, if non-@code{nil}, is a list that specifies regular |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1777 expressions for finding definitions for Imenu. Simple elements of |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1778 @code{imenu-generic-expression} look like this: |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1779 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1780 @example |
52744
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1781 (@var{menu-title} @var{regexp} @var{index}) |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1782 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1783 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1784 Here, if @var{menu-title} is non-@code{nil}, it says that the matches |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1785 for this element should go in a submenu of the buffer index; |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1786 @var{menu-title} itself specifies the name for the submenu. If |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1787 @var{menu-title} is @code{nil}, the matches for this element go directly |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1788 in the top level of the buffer index. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1789 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1790 The second item in the list, @var{regexp}, is a regular expression |
52744
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1791 (@pxref{Regular Expressions}); anything in the buffer that it matches |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1792 is considered a definition, something to mention in the buffer index. |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1793 The third item, @var{index}, is a non-negative integer that indicates |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1794 which subexpression in @var{regexp} matches the definition's name. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1795 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1796 An element can also look like this: |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1797 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1798 @example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1799 (@var{menu-title} @var{regexp} @var{index} @var{function} @var{arguments}@dots{}) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1800 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1801 |
52744
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1802 Like in the previous case, each match for this element creates an |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1803 index item. However, if this index item is selected by the user, it |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1804 calls @var{function} with arguments consisting of the item name, the |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1805 buffer position, and @var{arguments}. |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1806 |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1807 For Emacs Lisp mode, @code{imenu-generic-expression} could look like |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1808 this: |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1809 |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1810 @c should probably use imenu-syntax-alist and \\sw rather than [-A-Za-z0-9+] |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1811 @example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1812 @group |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1813 ((nil "^\\s-*(def\\(un\\|subst\\|macro\\|advice\\)\ |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1814 \\s-+\\([-A-Za-z0-9+]+\\)" 2) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1815 @end group |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1816 @group |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1817 ("*Vars*" "^\\s-*(def\\(var\\|const\\)\ |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1818 \\s-+\\([-A-Za-z0-9+]+\\)" 2) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1819 @end group |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1820 @group |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1821 ("*Types*" |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1822 "^\\s-*\ |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1823 (def\\(type\\|struct\\|class\\|ine-condition\\)\ |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1824 \\s-+\\([-A-Za-z0-9+]+\\)" 2)) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1825 @end group |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1826 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1827 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1828 Setting this variable makes it buffer-local in the current buffer. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1829 @end defvar |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1830 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1831 @defvar imenu-case-fold-search |
52744
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1832 This variable controls whether matching against the regular |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1833 expressions in the value of @code{imenu-generic-expression} is |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1834 case-sensitive: @code{t}, the default, means matching should ignore |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1835 case. |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1836 |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1837 Setting this variable makes it buffer-local in the current buffer. |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1838 @end defvar |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1839 |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1840 @defvar imenu-syntax-alist |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1841 This variable is an alist of syntax table modifiers to use while |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1842 processing @code{imenu-generic-expression}, to override the syntax table |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1843 of the current buffer. Each element should have this form: |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1844 |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1845 @example |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1846 (@var{characters} . @var{syntax-description}) |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1847 @end example |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1848 |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1849 The @sc{car}, @var{characters}, can be either a character or a string. |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1850 The element says to give that character or characters the syntax |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1851 specified by @var{syntax-description}, which is passed to |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1852 @code{modify-syntax-entry} (@pxref{Syntax Table Functions}). |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1853 |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1854 This feature is typically used to give word syntax to characters which |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1855 normally have symbol syntax, and thus to simplify |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1856 @code{imenu-generic-expression} and speed up matching. |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1857 For example, Fortran mode uses it this way: |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1858 |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1859 @example |
52001
b96d92c96bd1
(Imenu): Add xref to Emacs Manual node on Imenu.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51917
diff
changeset
|
1860 (setq imenu-syntax-alist '(("_$" . "w"))) |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1861 @end example |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1862 |
52744
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1863 The @code{imenu-generic-expression} regular expressions can then use |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1864 @samp{\\sw+} instead of @samp{\\(\\sw\\|\\s_\\)+}. Note that this |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1865 technique may be inconvenient when the mode needs to limit the initial |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1866 character of a name to a smaller set of characters than are allowed in |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1867 the rest of a name. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1868 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1869 Setting this variable makes it buffer-local in the current buffer. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1870 @end defvar |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1871 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1872 Another way to customize Imenu for a major mode is to set the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1873 variables @code{imenu-prev-index-position-function} and |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1874 @code{imenu-extract-index-name-function}: |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1875 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1876 @defvar imenu-prev-index-position-function |
27332
5cfe77eaff45
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
1877 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, its value should be a function that |
25875 | 1878 finds the next ``definition'' to put in the buffer index, scanning |
1879 backward in the buffer from point. It should return @code{nil} if it | |
48700 | 1880 doesn't find another ``definition'' before point. Otherwise it should |
25875 | 1881 leave point at the place it finds a ``definition,'' and return any |
1882 non-@code{nil} value. | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1883 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1884 Setting this variable makes it buffer-local in the current buffer. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1885 @end defvar |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1886 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1887 @defvar imenu-extract-index-name-function |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1888 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, its value should be a function to |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1889 return the name for a definition, assuming point is in that definition |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1890 as the @code{imenu-prev-index-position-function} function would leave |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1891 it. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1892 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1893 Setting this variable makes it buffer-local in the current buffer. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1894 @end defvar |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1895 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1896 The last way to customize Imenu for a major mode is to set the |
25875 | 1897 variable @code{imenu-create-index-function}: |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1898 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1899 @defvar imenu-create-index-function |
52744
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1900 This variable specifies the function to use for creating a buffer |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1901 index. The function should take no arguments, and return an index |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1902 alist for the current buffer. It is called within |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1903 @code{save-excursion}, so where it leaves point makes no difference. |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1904 |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1905 The index alist can have three types of elements. Simple elements |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1906 look like this: |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1907 |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1908 @example |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1909 (@var{index-name} . @var{index-position}) |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1910 @end example |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1911 |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1912 Selecting a simple element has the effect of moving to position |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1913 @var{index-position} in the buffer. Special elements look like this: |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1914 |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1915 @example |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1916 (@var{index-name} @var{index-position} @var{function} @var{arguments}@dots{}) |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1917 @end example |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1918 |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1919 Selecting a special element performs: |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1920 |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1921 @example |
52800
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
1922 (funcall @var{function} |
52744
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1923 @var{index-name} @var{index-position} @var{arguments}@dots{}) |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1924 @end example |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1925 |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1926 A nested sub-alist element looks like this: |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1927 |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1928 @example |
52802
675fbfca3a2a
(Imenu): Mention imenu-create-index-function's default value.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52800
diff
changeset
|
1929 (@var{menu-title} @var{sub-alist}) |
52744
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1930 @end example |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1931 |
52802
675fbfca3a2a
(Imenu): Mention imenu-create-index-function's default value.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52800
diff
changeset
|
1932 It creates the submenu @var{menu-title} specified by @var{sub-alist}. |
675fbfca3a2a
(Imenu): Mention imenu-create-index-function's default value.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52800
diff
changeset
|
1933 |
675fbfca3a2a
(Imenu): Mention imenu-create-index-function's default value.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52800
diff
changeset
|
1934 The default value of @code{imenu-create-index-function} is |
675fbfca3a2a
(Imenu): Mention imenu-create-index-function's default value.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52800
diff
changeset
|
1935 @code{imenu-default-create-index-function}. This function uses |
675fbfca3a2a
(Imenu): Mention imenu-create-index-function's default value.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52800
diff
changeset
|
1936 @code{imenu-prev-index-position-function} and |
52744
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1937 @code{imenu-extract-index-name-function} to produce the index alist. |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1938 However, if either of these two variables is @code{nil}, the default |
c81c292a982b
(Major Mode Conventions): Mention third way to set up Imenu.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52663
diff
changeset
|
1939 function uses @code{imenu-generic-expression} instead. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1940 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1941 Setting this variable makes it buffer-local in the current buffer. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1942 @end defvar |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1943 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1944 @node Font Lock Mode |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1945 @section Font Lock Mode |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1946 @cindex Font Lock Mode |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1947 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1948 @dfn{Font Lock mode} is a feature that automatically attaches |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1949 @code{face} properties to certain parts of the buffer based on their |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1950 syntactic role. How it parses the buffer depends on the major mode; |
25875 | 1951 most major modes define syntactic criteria for which faces to use in |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1952 which contexts. This section explains how to customize Font Lock for a |
25875 | 1953 particular major mode. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1954 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1955 Font Lock mode finds text to highlight in two ways: through syntactic |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1956 parsing based on the syntax table, and through searching (usually for |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1957 regular expressions). Syntactic fontification happens first; it finds |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1958 comments and string constants, and highlights them using |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1959 @code{font-lock-comment-face} and @code{font-lock-string-face} |
25875 | 1960 (@pxref{Faces for Font Lock}). Search-based fontification follows. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1961 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1962 @menu |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1963 * Font Lock Basics:: |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1964 * Search-based Fontification:: |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1965 * Other Font Lock Variables:: |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1966 * Levels of Font Lock:: |
45684
6f73f208b4ce
(Precalcuated Fontification): New node, describing `font-lock-face'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
43677
diff
changeset
|
1967 * Precalculated Fontification:: |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1968 * Faces for Font Lock:: |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1969 * Syntactic Font Lock:: |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1970 @end menu |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1971 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1972 @node Font Lock Basics |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1973 @subsection Font Lock Basics |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1974 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1975 There are several variables that control how Font Lock mode highlights |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1976 text. But major modes should not set any of these variables directly. |
24934 | 1977 Instead, they should set @code{font-lock-defaults} as a buffer-local |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1978 variable. The value assigned to this variable is used, if and when Font |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1979 Lock mode is enabled, to set all the other variables. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1980 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1981 @defvar font-lock-defaults |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1982 This variable is set by major modes, as a buffer-local variable, to |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1983 specify how to fontify text in that mode. The value should look like |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1984 this: |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1985 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1986 @example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1987 (@var{keywords} @var{keywords-only} @var{case-fold} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1988 @var{syntax-alist} @var{syntax-begin} @var{other-vars}@dots{}) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1989 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1990 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1991 The first element, @var{keywords}, indirectly specifies the value of |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1992 @code{font-lock-keywords}. It can be a symbol, a variable whose value |
25875 | 1993 is the list to use for @code{font-lock-keywords}. It can also be a list of |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1994 several such symbols, one for each possible level of fontification. The |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1995 first symbol specifies how to do level 1 fontification, the second |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1996 symbol how to do level 2, and so on. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1997 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
1998 The second element, @var{keywords-only}, specifies the value of the |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1999 variable @code{font-lock-keywords-only}. If this is non-@code{nil}, |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2000 syntactic fontification (of strings and comments) is not performed. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2001 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2002 The third element, @var{case-fold}, specifies the value of |
58231
e8e266a5fe20
(Font Lock Basics): Fix typo.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
57213
diff
changeset
|
2003 @code{font-lock-keywords-case-fold-search}. If it is non-@code{nil}, Font Lock |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2004 mode ignores case when searching as directed by |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2005 @code{font-lock-keywords}. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2006 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2007 If the fourth element, @var{syntax-alist}, is non-@code{nil}, it should be |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2008 a list of cons cells of the form @code{(@var{char-or-string} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2009 . @var{string})}. These are used to set up a syntax table for |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2010 fontification (@pxref{Syntax Table Functions}). The resulting syntax |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2011 table is stored in @code{font-lock-syntax-table}. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2012 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2013 The fifth element, @var{syntax-begin}, specifies the value of |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2014 @code{font-lock-beginning-of-syntax-function} (see below). |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2015 |
25875 | 2016 All the remaining elements (if any) are collectively called |
2017 @var{other-vars}. Each of these elements should have the form | |
2018 @code{(@var{variable} . @var{value})}---which means, make @var{variable} | |
2019 buffer-local and then set it to @var{value}. You can use these | |
2020 @var{other-vars} to set other variables that affect fontification, | |
2021 aside from those you can control with the first five elements. | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2022 @end defvar |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2023 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2024 @node Search-based Fontification |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2025 @subsection Search-based Fontification |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2026 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2027 The most important variable for customizing Font Lock mode is |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2028 @code{font-lock-keywords}. It specifies the search criteria for |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2029 search-based fontification. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2030 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2031 @defvar font-lock-keywords |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2032 This variable's value is a list of the keywords to highlight. Be |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2033 careful when composing regular expressions for this list; a poorly |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2034 written pattern can dramatically slow things down! |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2035 @end defvar |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2036 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2037 Each element of @code{font-lock-keywords} specifies how to find |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2038 certain cases of text, and how to highlight those cases. Font Lock mode |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2039 processes the elements of @code{font-lock-keywords} one by one, and for |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2040 each element, it finds and handles all matches. Ordinarily, once |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2041 part of the text has been fontified already, this cannot be overridden |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2042 by a subsequent match in the same text; but you can specify different |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2043 behavior using the @var{override} element of a @var{highlighter}. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2044 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2045 Each element of @code{font-lock-keywords} should have one of these |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2046 forms: |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2047 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2048 @table @code |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2049 @item @var{regexp} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2050 Highlight all matches for @var{regexp} using |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2051 @code{font-lock-keyword-face}. For example, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2052 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2053 @example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2054 ;; @r{Highlight discrete occurrences of @samp{foo}} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2055 ;; @r{using @code{font-lock-keyword-face}.} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2056 "\\<foo\\>" |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2057 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2058 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2059 The function @code{regexp-opt} (@pxref{Syntax of Regexps}) is useful for |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2060 calculating optimal regular expressions to match a number of different |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2061 keywords. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2062 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2063 @item @var{function} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2064 Find text by calling @var{function}, and highlight the matches |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2065 it finds using @code{font-lock-keyword-face}. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2066 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2067 When @var{function} is called, it receives one argument, the limit of |
55687
4d4340e24361
(Search-based Fontification): Fix typo.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
55508
diff
changeset
|
2068 the search; it should begin searching at point, and not search beyond the |
41938
f8c0a921c536
Improve doc of font-lock-keywords.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
40928
diff
changeset
|
2069 limit. It should return non-@code{nil} if it succeeds, and set the |
f8c0a921c536
Improve doc of font-lock-keywords.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
40928
diff
changeset
|
2070 match data to describe the match that was found. Returning @code{nil} |
f8c0a921c536
Improve doc of font-lock-keywords.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
40928
diff
changeset
|
2071 indicates failure of the search. |
f8c0a921c536
Improve doc of font-lock-keywords.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
40928
diff
changeset
|
2072 |
f8c0a921c536
Improve doc of font-lock-keywords.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
40928
diff
changeset
|
2073 Fontification will call @var{function} repeatedly with the same limit, |
f8c0a921c536
Improve doc of font-lock-keywords.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
40928
diff
changeset
|
2074 and with point where the previous invocation left it, until |
f8c0a921c536
Improve doc of font-lock-keywords.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
40928
diff
changeset
|
2075 @var{function} fails. On failure, @var{function} need not reset point |
f8c0a921c536
Improve doc of font-lock-keywords.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
40928
diff
changeset
|
2076 in any particular way. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2077 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2078 @item (@var{matcher} . @var{match}) |
24934 | 2079 In this kind of element, @var{matcher} is either a regular |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2080 expression or a function, as described above. The @sc{cdr}, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2081 @var{match}, specifies which subexpression of @var{matcher} should be |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2082 highlighted (instead of the entire text that @var{matcher} matched). |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2083 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2084 @example |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
2085 ;; @r{Highlight the @samp{bar} in each occurrence of @samp{fubar},} |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2086 ;; @r{using @code{font-lock-keyword-face}.} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2087 ("fu\\(bar\\)" . 1) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2088 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2089 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2090 If you use @code{regexp-opt} to produce the regular expression |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2091 @var{matcher}, then you can use @code{regexp-opt-depth} (@pxref{Syntax |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2092 of Regexps}) to calculate the value for @var{match}. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2093 |
53430
7abfe409def6
(Search-based Fontification): Explain that
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2094 @item (@var{matcher} . @var{facespec}) |
7abfe409def6
(Search-based Fontification): Explain that
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2095 In this kind of element, @var{facespec} is an object which specifies |
7abfe409def6
(Search-based Fontification): Explain that
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2096 the face variable to use for highlighting. In the simplest case, it |
7abfe409def6
(Search-based Fontification): Explain that
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2097 is a Lisp variable (a symbol), whose value should be a face name. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2098 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2099 @example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2100 ;; @r{Highlight occurrences of @samp{fubar},} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2101 ;; @r{using the face which is the value of @code{fubar-face}.} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2102 ("fubar" . fubar-face) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2103 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2104 |
53430
7abfe409def6
(Search-based Fontification): Explain that
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2105 However, @var{facespec} can also be a list of the form |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2106 |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2107 @example |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2108 (face @var{face} @var{prop1} @var{val1} @var{prop2} @var{val2}@dots{}) |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2109 @end example |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2110 |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2111 to specify various text properties to put on the text that matches. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2112 If you do this, be sure to add the other text property names that you |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2113 set in this way to the value of @code{font-lock-extra-managed-props} |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2114 so that the properties will also be cleared out when they are no longer |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2115 appropriate. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2116 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2117 @item (@var{matcher} . @var{highlighter}) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2118 In this kind of element, @var{highlighter} is a list |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2119 which specifies how to highlight matches found by @var{matcher}. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2120 It has the form |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2121 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2122 @example |
53430
7abfe409def6
(Search-based Fontification): Explain that
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2123 (@var{subexp} @var{facespec} @var{override} @var{laxmatch}) |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2124 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2125 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2126 The @sc{car}, @var{subexp}, is an integer specifying which subexpression |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2127 of the match to fontify (0 means the entire matching text). The second |
53430
7abfe409def6
(Search-based Fontification): Explain that
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2128 subelement, @var{facespec}, specifies the face, as described above. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2129 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2130 The last two values in @var{highlighter}, @var{override} and |
52187
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
2131 @var{laxmatch}, are flags. If @var{override} is @code{t}, this |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
2132 element can override existing fontification made by previous elements |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
2133 of @code{font-lock-keywords}. If it is @code{keep}, then each |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
2134 character is fontified if it has not been fontified already by some |
53430
7abfe409def6
(Search-based Fontification): Explain that
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2135 other element. If it is @code{prepend}, the face specified by |
7abfe409def6
(Search-based Fontification): Explain that
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2136 @var{facespec} is added to the beginning of the @code{font-lock-face} |
7abfe409def6
(Search-based Fontification): Explain that
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2137 property. If it is @code{append}, the face is added to the end of the |
52187
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
2138 @code{font-lock-face} property. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2139 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2140 If @var{laxmatch} is non-@code{nil}, it means there should be no error |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2141 if there is no subexpression numbered @var{subexp} in @var{matcher}. |
25975
e368b754fe25
Add patch from rms around line 1870.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25950
diff
changeset
|
2142 Obviously, fontification of the subexpression numbered @var{subexp} will |
e368b754fe25
Add patch from rms around line 1870.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25950
diff
changeset
|
2143 not occur. However, fontification of other subexpressions (and other |
e368b754fe25
Add patch from rms around line 1870.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25950
diff
changeset
|
2144 regexps) will continue. If @var{laxmatch} is @code{nil}, and the |
57213
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
2145 specified subexpression is missing, then an error is signaled which |
25975
e368b754fe25
Add patch from rms around line 1870.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25950
diff
changeset
|
2146 terminates search-based fontification. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2147 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2148 Here are some examples of elements of this kind, and what they do: |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2149 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2150 @smallexample |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2151 ;; @r{Highlight occurrences of either @samp{foo} or @samp{bar},} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2152 ;; @r{using @code{foo-bar-face}, even if they have already been highlighted.} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2153 ;; @r{@code{foo-bar-face} should be a variable whose value is a face.} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2154 ("foo\\|bar" 0 foo-bar-face t) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2155 |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
24934
diff
changeset
|
2156 ;; @r{Highlight the first subexpression within each occurrence} |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2157 ;; @r{that the function @code{fubar-match} finds,} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2158 ;; @r{using the face which is the value of @code{fubar-face}.} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2159 (fubar-match 1 fubar-face) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2160 @end smallexample |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2161 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2162 @item (@var{matcher} @var{highlighters}@dots{}) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2163 This sort of element specifies several @var{highlighter} lists for a |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2164 single @var{matcher}. In order for this to be useful, each |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2165 @var{highlighter} should have a different value of @var{subexp}; that is, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2166 each one should apply to a different subexpression of @var{matcher}. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2167 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2168 @ignore |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2169 @item (@var{matcher} . @var{anchored}) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2170 In this kind of element, @var{anchored} acts much like a |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2171 @var{highlighter}, but it is more complex and can specify multiple |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2172 successive searches. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2173 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2174 For highlighting single items, typically only @var{highlighter} is |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2175 required. However, if an item or (typically) items are to be |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2176 highlighted following the instance of another item (the anchor) then |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2177 @var{anchored} may be required. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2178 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2179 It has this format: |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2180 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2181 @example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2182 (@var{submatcher} @var{pre-match-form} @var{post-match-form} @var{highlighters}@dots{}) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2183 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2184 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2185 @c I can't parse this text -- rms |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2186 where @var{submatcher} is much like @var{matcher}, with one |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2187 exception---see below. @var{pre-match-form} and @var{post-match-form} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2188 are evaluated before the first, and after the last, instance |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2189 @var{anchored}'s @var{submatcher} is used. Therefore they can be used |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2190 to initialize before, and cleanup after, @var{submatcher} is used. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2191 Typically, @var{pre-match-form} is used to move to some position |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2192 relative to the original @var{submatcher}, before starting with |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2193 @var{anchored}'s @var{submatcher}. @var{post-match-form} might be used |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2194 to move, before resuming with @var{anchored}'s parent's @var{matcher}. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2195 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2196 For example, an element of the form highlights (if not already highlighted): |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2197 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2198 @example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2199 ("\\<anchor\\>" (0 anchor-face) ("\\<item\\>" nil nil (0 item-face))) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2200 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2201 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2202 Discrete occurrences of @samp{anchor} in the value of |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2203 @code{anchor-face}, and subsequent discrete occurrences of @samp{item} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2204 (on the same line) in the value of @code{item-face}. (Here |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2205 @var{pre-match-form} and @var{post-match-form} are @code{nil}. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2206 Therefore @samp{item} is initially searched for starting from the end of |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2207 the match of @samp{anchor}, and searching for subsequent instance of |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2208 @samp{anchor} resumes from where searching for @samp{item} concluded.) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2209 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2210 The above-mentioned exception is as follows. The limit of the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2211 @var{submatcher} search defaults to the end of the line after |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2212 @var{pre-match-form} is evaluated. However, if @var{pre-match-form} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2213 returns a position greater than the position after @var{pre-match-form} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2214 is evaluated, that position is used as the limit of the search. It is |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2215 generally a bad idea to return a position greater than the end of the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2216 line; in other words, the @var{submatcher} search should not span lines. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2217 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2218 @item (@var{matcher} @var{highlighters-or-anchoreds} ...) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2219 @end ignore |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2220 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2221 @item (eval . @var{form}) |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2222 Here @var{form} is an expression to be evaluated the first time |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2223 this value of @code{font-lock-keywords} is used in a buffer. |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2224 Its value should have one of the forms described in this table. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2225 @end table |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2226 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2227 @strong{Warning:} Do not design an element of @code{font-lock-keywords} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2228 to match text which spans lines; this does not work reliably. While |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2229 @code{font-lock-fontify-buffer} handles multi-line patterns correctly, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2230 updating when you edit the buffer does not, since it considers text one |
52956
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2231 line at a time. If you have patterns that typically only span one |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2232 line but can occasionally span two or three, such as |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2233 @samp{<title>...</title>}, you can ask font-lock to be more careful by |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2234 setting @code{font-lock-multiline} to @code{t}. But it still will not |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2235 work in all cases. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2236 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2237 @node Other Font Lock Variables |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2238 @subsection Other Font Lock Variables |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2239 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2240 This section describes additional variables that a major mode |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2241 can set by means of @code{font-lock-defaults}. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2242 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2243 @defvar font-lock-keywords-only |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2244 Non-@code{nil} means Font Lock should not fontify comments or strings |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2245 syntactically; it should only fontify based on |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2246 @code{font-lock-keywords}. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2247 @end defvar |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2248 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2249 @ignore |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2250 Other variables include those for buffer-specialized fontification functions, |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2251 `font-lock-fontify-buffer-function', `font-lock-unfontify-buffer-function', |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2252 `font-lock-fontify-region-function', `font-lock-unfontify-region-function', |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2253 `font-lock-inhibit-thing-lock' and `font-lock-maximum-size'. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2254 @end ignore |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2255 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2256 @defvar font-lock-keywords-case-fold-search |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2257 Non-@code{nil} means that regular expression matching for the sake of |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2258 @code{font-lock-keywords} should be case-insensitive. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2259 @end defvar |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2260 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2261 @defvar font-lock-syntax-table |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2262 This variable specifies the syntax table to use for fontification of |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2263 comments and strings. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2264 @end defvar |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2265 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2266 @defvar font-lock-beginning-of-syntax-function |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2267 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a function to move |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2268 point back to a position that is syntactically at ``top level'' and |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2269 outside of strings or comments. Font Lock uses this when necessary |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2270 to get the right results for syntactic fontification. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2271 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2272 This function is called with no arguments. It should leave point at the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2273 beginning of any enclosing syntactic block. Typical values are |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2274 @code{beginning-of-line} (i.e., the start of the line is known to be |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2275 outside a syntactic block), or @code{beginning-of-defun} for programming |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2276 modes or @code{backward-paragraph} for textual modes (i.e., the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2277 mode-dependent function is known to move outside a syntactic block). |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2278 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2279 If the value is @code{nil}, the beginning of the buffer is used as a |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2280 position outside of a syntactic block. This cannot be wrong, but it can |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2281 be slow. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2282 @end defvar |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2283 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2284 @defvar font-lock-mark-block-function |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2285 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a function that is |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2286 called with no arguments, to choose an enclosing range of text for |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2287 refontification for the command @kbd{M-g M-g} |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2288 (@code{font-lock-fontify-block}). |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2289 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2290 The function should report its choice by placing the region around it. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2291 A good choice is a range of text large enough to give proper results, |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2292 but not too large so that refontification becomes slow. Typical values |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2293 are @code{mark-defun} for programming modes or @code{mark-paragraph} for |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2294 textual modes. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2295 @end defvar |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2296 |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2297 @defvar font-lock-extra-managed-props |
52187
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
2298 Additional properties (other than @code{font-lock-face}) that are |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
2299 being managed by Font Lock mode. Font Lock mode normally manages only |
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
2300 the @code{font-lock-face} property; if you want it to manage others as |
53430
7abfe409def6
(Search-based Fontification): Explain that
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52978
diff
changeset
|
2301 well, you must specify them in a @var{facespec} in |
52187
a39b6df244a7
(Emulating Mode Line): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52001
diff
changeset
|
2302 @code{font-lock-keywords} as well as adding them to this list. |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2303 @end defvar |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2304 |
52956
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2305 @defvar font-lock-syntactic-face-function |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2306 A function to determine which face to use for a given syntactic |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2307 element (a string or a comment). The function is called with one |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2308 argument, the parse state at point returned by |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2309 @code{parse-partial-sexp}, and should return a face. The default |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2310 value returns @code{font-lock-comment-face} for comments and |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2311 @code{font-lock-string-face} for strings. |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2312 |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2313 This can be used to highlighting different kinds of strings or |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2314 comments differently. It is also sometimes abused together with |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2315 @code{font-lock-syntactic-keywords} to highlight elements that span |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2316 multiple lines, but this is too obscure to document in this manual. |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2317 @end defvar |
667459455d3c
Document the existance of font-lock-syntactic-face-function and
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
52859
diff
changeset
|
2318 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2319 @node Levels of Font Lock |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2320 @subsection Levels of Font Lock |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2321 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2322 Many major modes offer three different levels of fontification. You |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2323 can define multiple levels by using a list of symbols for @var{keywords} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2324 in @code{font-lock-defaults}. Each symbol specifies one level of |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2325 fontification; it is up to the user to choose one of these levels. The |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2326 chosen level's symbol value is used to initialize |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2327 @code{font-lock-keywords}. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2328 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2329 Here are the conventions for how to define the levels of |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2330 fontification: |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2331 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2332 @itemize @bullet |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2333 @item |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2334 Level 1: highlight function declarations, file directives (such as include or |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2335 import directives), strings and comments. The idea is speed, so only |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2336 the most important and top-level components are fontified. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2337 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2338 @item |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2339 Level 2: in addition to level 1, highlight all language keywords, |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2340 including type names that act like keywords, as well as named constant |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2341 values. The idea is that all keywords (either syntactic or semantic) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2342 should be fontified appropriately. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2343 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2344 @item |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2345 Level 3: in addition to level 2, highlight the symbols being defined in |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2346 function and variable declarations, and all builtin function names, |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2347 wherever they appear. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2348 @end itemize |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2349 |
45684
6f73f208b4ce
(Precalcuated Fontification): New node, describing `font-lock-face'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
43677
diff
changeset
|
2350 @node Precalculated Fontification |
6f73f208b4ce
(Precalcuated Fontification): New node, describing `font-lock-face'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
43677
diff
changeset
|
2351 @subsection Precalculated Fontification |
6f73f208b4ce
(Precalcuated Fontification): New node, describing `font-lock-face'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
43677
diff
changeset
|
2352 |
6f73f208b4ce
(Precalcuated Fontification): New node, describing `font-lock-face'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
43677
diff
changeset
|
2353 In addition to using @code{font-lock-defaults} for search-based |
6f73f208b4ce
(Precalcuated Fontification): New node, describing `font-lock-face'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
43677
diff
changeset
|
2354 fontification, you may use the special character property |
6f73f208b4ce
(Precalcuated Fontification): New node, describing `font-lock-face'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
43677
diff
changeset
|
2355 @code{font-lock-face} (@pxref{Special Properties}). This property |
6f73f208b4ce
(Precalcuated Fontification): New node, describing `font-lock-face'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
43677
diff
changeset
|
2356 acts just like the explicit @code{face} property, but its activation |
6f73f208b4ce
(Precalcuated Fontification): New node, describing `font-lock-face'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
43677
diff
changeset
|
2357 is toggled when the user calls @kbd{M-x font-lock-mode}. Using |
52628
74d358d76ea8
(Mode Line Data): Document the :propertize construct.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52463
diff
changeset
|
2358 @code{font-lock-face} is especially convenient for special modes |
45684
6f73f208b4ce
(Precalcuated Fontification): New node, describing `font-lock-face'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
43677
diff
changeset
|
2359 which construct their text programmatically, such as |
6f73f208b4ce
(Precalcuated Fontification): New node, describing `font-lock-face'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
43677
diff
changeset
|
2360 @code{list-buffers} and @code{occur}. |
6f73f208b4ce
(Precalcuated Fontification): New node, describing `font-lock-face'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
43677
diff
changeset
|
2361 |
45714
7057566fa4c1
(Precalcuated Fontification): Note how to use `font-lock-core-only'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45684
diff
changeset
|
2362 If your mode does not use any of the other machinery of Font Lock |
7057566fa4c1
(Precalcuated Fontification): Note how to use `font-lock-core-only'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45684
diff
changeset
|
2363 (i.e. it only uses the @code{font-lock-face} property), you can tell |
7057566fa4c1
(Precalcuated Fontification): Note how to use `font-lock-core-only'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45684
diff
changeset
|
2364 Emacs not to load all of font-lock.el (unless it's already loaded), by |
51703
b8860fc285cb
Minor Texinfo usage fix.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51021
diff
changeset
|
2365 setting the variable @code{font-lock-core-only} to non-@code{nil} as |
b8860fc285cb
Minor Texinfo usage fix.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51021
diff
changeset
|
2366 part of the @code{font-lock-defaults} settings. Here is the canonical |
b8860fc285cb
Minor Texinfo usage fix.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51021
diff
changeset
|
2367 way to do this: |
45714
7057566fa4c1
(Precalcuated Fontification): Note how to use `font-lock-core-only'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45684
diff
changeset
|
2368 |
7057566fa4c1
(Precalcuated Fontification): Note how to use `font-lock-core-only'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45684
diff
changeset
|
2369 @example |
7057566fa4c1
(Precalcuated Fontification): Note how to use `font-lock-core-only'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45684
diff
changeset
|
2370 (set (make-local-variable 'font-lock-defaults) |
7057566fa4c1
(Precalcuated Fontification): Note how to use `font-lock-core-only'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45684
diff
changeset
|
2371 '(nil t nil nil nil (font-lock-core-only . t))) |
7057566fa4c1
(Precalcuated Fontification): Note how to use `font-lock-core-only'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45684
diff
changeset
|
2372 @end example |
7057566fa4c1
(Precalcuated Fontification): Note how to use `font-lock-core-only'.
Colin Walters <walters@gnu.org>
parents:
45684
diff
changeset
|
2373 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2374 @node Faces for Font Lock |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2375 @subsection Faces for Font Lock |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2376 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2377 You can make Font Lock mode use any face, but several faces are |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2378 defined specifically for Font Lock mode. Each of these symbols is both |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2379 a face name, and a variable whose default value is the symbol itself. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2380 Thus, the default value of @code{font-lock-comment-face} is |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2381 @code{font-lock-comment-face}. This means you can write |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2382 @code{font-lock-comment-face} in a context such as |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2383 @code{font-lock-keywords} where a face-name-valued expression is used. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2384 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2385 @table @code |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2386 @item font-lock-comment-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2387 @vindex font-lock-comment-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2388 Used (typically) for comments. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2389 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2390 @item font-lock-string-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2391 @vindex font-lock-string-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2392 Used (typically) for string constants. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2393 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2394 @item font-lock-keyword-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2395 @vindex font-lock-keyword-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2396 Used (typically) for keywords---names that have special syntactic |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2397 significance, like @code{for} and @code{if} in C. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2398 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2399 @item font-lock-builtin-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2400 @vindex font-lock-builtin-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2401 Used (typically) for built-in function names. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2402 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2403 @item font-lock-function-name-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2404 @vindex font-lock-function-name-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2405 Used (typically) for the name of a function being defined or declared, |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
48700
diff
changeset
|
2406 in a function definition or declaration. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2407 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2408 @item font-lock-variable-name-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2409 @vindex font-lock-variable-name-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2410 Used (typically) for the name of a variable being defined or declared, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2411 in a variable definition or declaration. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2412 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2413 @item font-lock-type-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2414 @vindex font-lock-type-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2415 Used (typically) for names of user-defined data types, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2416 where they are defined and where they are used. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2417 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2418 @item font-lock-constant-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2419 @vindex font-lock-constant-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2420 Used (typically) for constant names. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2421 |
52800
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2422 @item font-lock-preprocessor-face |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2423 @vindex font-lock-preprocessor-face |
51917
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2424 Used (typically) for preprocessor commands. |
3039afbb0746
(Major Mode Conventions): Explain about run-mode-hooks and about derived modes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51794
diff
changeset
|
2425 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2426 @item font-lock-warning-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2427 @vindex font-lock-warning-face |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2428 Used (typically) for constructs that are peculiar, or that greatly |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2429 change the meaning of other text. For example, this is used for |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2430 @samp{;;;###autoload} cookies in Emacs Lisp, and for @code{#error} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2431 directives in C. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2432 @end table |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2433 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2434 @node Syntactic Font Lock |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2435 @subsection Syntactic Font Lock |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2436 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2437 Font Lock mode can be used to update @code{syntax-table} properties |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2438 automatically. This is useful in languages for which a single syntax |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2439 table by itself is not sufficient. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2440 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2441 @defvar font-lock-syntactic-keywords |
50693
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2442 This variable enables and controls syntactic Font Lock. It is |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2443 normally set via @code{font-lock-defaults}. Its value should be a |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2444 list of elements of this form: |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2445 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2446 @example |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2447 (@var{matcher} @var{subexp} @var{syntax} @var{override} @var{laxmatch}) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2448 @end example |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2449 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2450 The parts of this element have the same meanings as in the corresponding |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2451 sort of element of @code{font-lock-keywords}, |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2452 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2453 @example |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2454 (@var{matcher} @var{subexp} @var{facename} @var{override} @var{laxmatch}) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2455 @end example |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2456 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2457 However, instead of specifying the value @var{facename} to use for the |
50693
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2458 @code{face} property, it specifies the value @var{syntax} to use for |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2459 the @code{syntax-table} property. Here, @var{syntax} can be a string |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2460 (as taken by @code{modify-syntax-entry}), a syntax table, a cons cell |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2461 (as returned by @code{string-to-syntax}), or an expression whose value |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2462 is one of those two types. @var{override} cannot be @code{prepend} or |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2463 @code{append}. |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2464 |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2465 For example, an element of the form: |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2466 |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2467 @example |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2468 ("\\$\\(#\\)" 1 ".") |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2469 @end example |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2470 |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2471 highlights syntactically a hash character when following a dollar |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2472 character, with a SYNTAX of @code{"."} (meaning punctuation syntax). |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2473 Assuming that the buffer syntax table specifies hash characters to |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2474 have comment start syntax, the element will only highlight hash |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2475 characters that do not follow dollar characters as comments |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2476 syntactically. |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2477 |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2478 An element of the form: |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2479 |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2480 @example |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2481 ("\\('\\).\\('\\)" |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2482 (1 "\"") |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2483 (2 "\"")) |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2484 @end example |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2485 |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2486 highlights syntactically both single quotes which surround a single |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2487 character, with a SYNTAX of @code{"\""} (meaning string quote syntax). |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2488 Assuming that the buffer syntax table does not specify single quotes |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2489 to have quote syntax, the element will only highlight single quotes of |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2490 the form @samp{'@var{c}'} as strings syntactically. Other forms, such |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2491 as @samp{foo'bar} or @samp{'fubar'}, will not be highlighted as |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2492 strings. |
17c60796aa6a
(font-lock-syntactic-keywords): Fix/expand description.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
2493 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2494 @end defvar |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2495 |
55414 | 2496 @node Desktop Save Mode |
2497 @section Desktop Save Mode | |
2498 @cindex desktop save mode | |
2499 | |
2500 @dfn{Desktop Save Mode} is a feature to save the state of Emacs from | |
2501 one session to another. The user-level commands for using Desktop | |
2502 Save Mode are described in the GNU Emacs Manual (@pxref{Saving Emacs | |
2503 Sessions,,, emacs, the GNU Emacs Manual}). Modes whose buffers visit | |
2504 a file, don't have to do anything to use this feature. | |
2505 | |
2506 For buffers not visiting a file to have their state saved, the major | |
2507 mode must bind the buffer local variable @code{desktop-save-buffer} to | |
57213
3497eca006fe
Various minor changes in addition to:
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents:
56768
diff
changeset
|
2508 a non-@code{nil} value. |
55414 | 2509 |
2510 @defvar desktop-save-buffer | |
2511 If this buffer-local variable is non-@code{nil}, the buffer will have | |
2512 its state saved in the desktop file at desktop save. If the value is | |
2513 a function, it is called at desktop save with argument | |
2514 @var{desktop-dirname}, and its value is saved in the desktop file along | |
2515 with the state of the buffer for which it was called. When file names | |
2516 are returned as part of the auxiliary information, they should be | |
2517 formatted using the call | |
2518 | |
2519 @example | |
2520 (desktop-file-name @var{file-name} @var{desktop-dirname}) | |
2521 @end example | |
2522 | |
2523 @end defvar | |
2524 | |
2525 For buffers not visiting a file to be restored, the major mode must | |
2526 define a function to do the job, and that function must be listed in | |
2527 the alist @code{desktop-buffer-mode-handlers}. | |
2528 | |
2529 @defvar desktop-buffer-mode-handlers | |
2530 Alist with elements | |
2531 | |
2532 @example | |
2533 (@var{major-mode} . @var{restore-buffer-function}) | |
2534 @end example | |
2535 | |
2536 The function @var{restore-buffer-function} will be called with | |
2537 argument list | |
2538 | |
2539 @example | |
2540 (@var{buffer-file-name} @var{buffer-name} @var{desktop-buffer-misc}) | |
2541 @end example | |
2542 | |
2543 and it should return the restored buffer. | |
2544 Here @var{desktop-buffer-misc} is the value returned by the function | |
2545 optionally bound to @code{desktop-save-buffer}. | |
2546 | |
2547 @end defvar | |
2548 | |
6451 | 2549 @node Hooks |
2550 @section Hooks | |
2551 @cindex hooks | |
2552 | |
2553 A @dfn{hook} is a variable where you can store a function or functions | |
2554 to be called on a particular occasion by an existing program. Emacs | |
2555 provides hooks for the sake of customization. Most often, hooks are set | |
25875 | 2556 up in the init file (@pxref{Init File}), but Lisp programs can set them also. |
6451 | 2557 @xref{Standard Hooks}, for a list of standard hook variables. |
2558 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2559 @cindex normal hook |
6451 | 2560 Most of the hooks in Emacs are @dfn{normal hooks}. These variables |
16056
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2561 contain lists of functions to be called with no arguments. When the |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2562 hook name ends in @samp{-hook}, that tells you it is normal. We try to |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2563 make all hooks normal, as much as possible, so that you can use them in |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2564 a uniform way. |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2565 |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2566 Every major mode function is supposed to run a normal hook called the |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2567 @dfn{mode hook} as the last step of initialization. This makes it easy |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2568 for a user to customize the behavior of the mode, by overriding the |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2569 buffer-local variable assignments already made by the mode. But hooks |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2570 are used in other contexts too. For example, the hook |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2571 @code{suspend-hook} runs just before Emacs suspends itself |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2572 (@pxref{Suspending Emacs}). |
6451 | 2573 |
2574 The recommended way to add a hook function to a normal hook is by | |
2575 calling @code{add-hook} (see below). The hook functions may be any of | |
52841
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2576 the valid kinds of functions that @code{funcall} accepts (@pxref{What |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2577 Is a Function}). Most normal hook variables are initially void; |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2578 @code{add-hook} knows how to deal with this. You can add hooks either |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2579 globally or buffer-locally with @code{add-hook}. |
52800
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2580 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17278
diff
changeset
|
2581 @cindex abnormal hook |
16056
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2582 If the hook variable's name does not end with @samp{-hook}, that |
25875 | 2583 indicates it is probably an @dfn{abnormal hook}. Then you should look at its |
16056
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2584 documentation to see how to use the hook properly. |
6451 | 2585 |
16056
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2586 If the variable's name ends in @samp{-functions} or @samp{-hooks}, |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2587 then the value is a list of functions, but it is abnormal in that either |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2588 these functions are called with arguments or their values are used in |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2589 some way. You can use @code{add-hook} to add a function to the list, |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2590 but you must take care in writing the function. (A few of these |
43264
91a36592ab22
*** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
42866
diff
changeset
|
2591 variables, notably those ending in @samp{-hooks}, are actually |
91a36592ab22
*** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
42866
diff
changeset
|
2592 normal hooks which were named before we established the convention of |
91a36592ab22
*** empty log message ***
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
42866
diff
changeset
|
2593 using @samp{-hook} for them.) |
16056
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2594 |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2595 If the variable's name ends in @samp{-function}, then its value |
bfe1d6597f08
Explain better about abnormal hooks.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12888
diff
changeset
|
2596 is just a single function, not a list of functions. |
6451 | 2597 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2598 Here's an example that uses a mode hook to turn on Auto Fill mode when |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2599 in Lisp Interaction mode: |
6451 | 2600 |
2601 @example | |
2602 (add-hook 'lisp-interaction-mode-hook 'turn-on-auto-fill) | |
2603 @end example | |
2604 | |
2605 At the appropriate time, Emacs uses the @code{run-hooks} function to | |
12098 | 2606 run particular hooks. This function calls the hook functions that have |
2607 been added with @code{add-hook}. | |
6451 | 2608 |
25875 | 2609 @defun run-hooks &rest hookvars |
52800
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2610 This function takes one or more normal hook variable names as |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2611 arguments, and runs each hook in turn. Each argument should be a |
52841
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2612 symbol that is a normal hook variable. These arguments are processed |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2613 in the order specified. |
6451 | 2614 |
2615 If a hook variable has a non-@code{nil} value, that value may be a | |
52841
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2616 function or a list of functions. (The former option is considered |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2617 obsolete.) If the value is a function (either a lambda expression or |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2618 a symbol with a function definition), it is called. If it is a list |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2619 that isn't a function, its elements are called, consecutively. All |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2620 the hook functions are called with no arguments. |
6451 | 2621 @end defun |
2622 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2623 @defun run-hook-with-args hook &rest args |
52841
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2624 This function is the way to run an abnormal hook and always call all |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2625 of the hook functions. It calls each of the hook functions one by |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2626 one, passing each of them the arguments @var{args}. |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2627 @end defun |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2628 |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2629 @defun run-hook-with-args-until-failure hook &rest args |
52800
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2630 This function is the way to run an abnormal hook until one of the hook |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2631 functions fails. It calls each of the hook functions, passing each of |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2632 them the arguments @var{args}, until some hook function returns |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2633 @code{nil}. It then stops and returns @code{nil}. If none of the |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2634 hook functions return @code{nil}, it returns a non-@code{nil} value. |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2635 @end defun |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2636 |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2637 @defun run-hook-with-args-until-success hook &rest args |
52800
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2638 This function is the way to run an abnormal hook until a hook function |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2639 succeeds. It calls each of the hook functions, passing each of them |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2640 the arguments @var{args}, until some hook function returns |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2641 non-@code{nil}. Then it stops, and returns whatever was returned by |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2642 the last hook function that was called. If all hook functions return |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2643 @code{nil}, it returns @code{nil} as well. |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2644 @end defun |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2645 |
12067 | 2646 @defun add-hook hook function &optional append local |
6451 | 2647 This function is the handy way to add function @var{function} to hook |
52841
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2648 variable @var{hook}. You can use it for abnormal hooks as well as for |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2649 normal hooks. @var{function} can be any Lisp function that can accept |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2650 the proper number of arguments for @var{hook}. For example, |
6451 | 2651 |
2652 @example | |
2653 (add-hook 'text-mode-hook 'my-text-hook-function) | |
2654 @end example | |
2655 | |
2656 @noindent | |
2657 adds @code{my-text-hook-function} to the hook called @code{text-mode-hook}. | |
2658 | |
52841
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2659 If @var{function} is already present in @var{hook} (comparing using |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2660 @code{equal}), then @code{add-hook} does not add it a second time. |
7253
6ba87aed7836
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6451
diff
changeset
|
2661 |
6451 | 2662 It is best to design your hook functions so that the order in which they |
2663 are executed does not matter. Any dependence on the order is ``asking | |
52800
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2664 for trouble''. However, the order is predictable: normally, |
6451 | 2665 @var{function} goes at the front of the hook list, so it will be |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2666 executed first (barring another @code{add-hook} call). If the optional |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2667 argument @var{append} is non-@code{nil}, the new hook function goes at |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2668 the end of the hook list and will be executed last. |
6451 | 2669 |
52800
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2670 If @var{local} is non-@code{nil}, that says to add @var{function} to |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2671 the buffer-local hook list instead of to the global hook list. If |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2672 needed, this makes the hook buffer-local and adds @code{t} to the |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2673 buffer-local value. The latter acts as a flag to run the hook |
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2674 functions in the default value as well as in the local value. |
6451 | 2675 @end defun |
8929
d7dc9a5b8c70
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
8505
diff
changeset
|
2676 |
12067 | 2677 @defun remove-hook hook function &optional local |
52800
d738115b4197
(Faces for Font Lock): Fix typo.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents:
52744
diff
changeset
|
2678 This function removes @var{function} from the hook variable |
52841
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2679 @var{hook}. It compares @var{function} with elements of @var{hook} |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2680 using @code{equal}, so it works for both symbols and lambda |
9a39d5c2148a
(Hooks): Don't explain local hook details here.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
52802
diff
changeset
|
2681 expressions. |
12067 | 2682 |
2683 If @var{local} is non-@code{nil}, that says to remove @var{function} | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2684 from the buffer-local hook list instead of from the global hook list. |
12067 | 2685 @end defun |
52401 | 2686 |
2687 @ignore | |
2688 arch-tag: 4c7bff41-36e6-4da6-9e7f-9b9289e27c8e | |
2689 @end ignore |